* [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 0/6] Add code-signing-provider template, add code signing docs @ 2020-06-17 14:31 Bastian Krause 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 1/6] ptxd_lib_template: add ptxd_template_read_options Bastian Krause ` (5 more replies) 0 siblings, 6 replies; 24+ messages in thread From: Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-17 14:31 UTC (permalink / raw) To: ptxdist; +Cc: Bastian Krause The code signing infrastructure is available since 2019 in PTXdist. Now it's time to document it, especially since RAUC also uses it. Unfortunately this did not make it into ptxdist-2020.06.0. To make things easier introduce a code-signing-provider template. Changes since v2: - introduce ptxd_template_read_options letting the user decide between limited options - ask user about HSM type - split HSM/SoftHSM ptxdist-set-keys.sh cases into separate files - introduce wizard.sh to generate ptxdist-set-keys.sh HSM case specific - set dependencies HSM case specific - introduce pre rule template to extend CODE_SIGNING_ENV HSM case specific - rename srk object name for consistency reasons - adjust doc section "Creating Custom Code Signing Providers" to updated code signing provider templates - remove "necessary package dependencies for code signing provider" from ref_code_signing_helpers, generated code signing providers now select all necessary host tools by default Changes since (implicit) v1: - rebased on master - reference code signing consumers section in ref_code_signing_helpers - split into sections: {SoftHSM Provider,Generic Provider,Consumer} Functions - add introductory sentence for each section - added Reviewed-by Roland - added Tested-by Ladis Bastian Krause (6): ptxd_lib_template: add ptxd_template_read_options package templates: add code-signing-provider template doc: dev_manual: split up into multiple files doc: move code signing docs from scripts/ into doc/ doc: dev_code_signing: rework and extend code signing section doc: introduce ref_code_signing_helpers doc/dev_add_bin_only_files.rst | 105 + doc/dev_add_new_pkgs.rst | 1339 +++++++++++++ doc/dev_code_signing.rst | 138 ++ doc/dev_create_new_pkg_templates.rst | 77 + doc/dev_dir_hierarchy.rst | 108 + doc/dev_layers_in_ptxdist.rst | 111 ++ doc/dev_manual.rst | 1765 +---------------- doc/ref_code_signing_helpers.rst | 248 +++ doc/ref_manual.rst | 1 + .../ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh | 42 + .../ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh | 58 + .../templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh | 10 + .../template-code-signing-provider-choice-in | 5 + .../template-code-signing-provider-in | 14 + .../template-code-signing-provider-make | 41 + .../template-code-signing-provider-pre-make | 15 + scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_code_signing.sh | 32 +- scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh | 57 + 18 files changed, 2381 insertions(+), 1785 deletions(-) create mode 100644 doc/dev_add_bin_only_files.rst create mode 100644 doc/dev_add_new_pkgs.rst create mode 100644 doc/dev_code_signing.rst create mode 100644 doc/dev_create_new_pkg_templates.rst create mode 100644 doc/dev_dir_hierarchy.rst create mode 100644 doc/dev_layers_in_ptxdist.rst create mode 100644 doc/ref_code_signing_helpers.rst create mode 100755 rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh create mode 100755 rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh create mode 100644 rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make -- 2.27.0 _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 1/6] ptxd_lib_template: add ptxd_template_read_options 2020-06-17 14:31 [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 0/6] Add code-signing-provider template, add code signing docs Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-17 14:31 ` Bastian Krause 2020-06-19 6:24 ` Michael Olbrich 2020-06-19 22:04 ` [ptxdist] [APPLIED] " Michael Olbrich 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 2/6] package templates: add code-signing-provider template Bastian Krause ` (4 subsequent siblings) 5 siblings, 2 replies; 24+ messages in thread From: Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-17 14:31 UTC (permalink / raw) To: ptxdist; +Cc: Bastian Krause Read a variable from user input, limited to a set of options. Example: $ ptxd_template_read_options "select your option" TYPE "option A" "option B" "option C" ptxdist: select option by number: ptxdist: [1] option A ptxdist: [2] option B ptxdist: [3] option C ptxdist: select your option................: 2 $ echo $TYPE option B The user can select 1, 2 or 3. Other input is not accepted. Signed-off-by: Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> --- Introduced in v3. Used to ask user about HSM type in a later commit. --- scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh | 26 ++++++++++++++++++++++++++ 1 file changed, 26 insertions(+) diff --git a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh index f39e6e033..6b405763b 100644 --- a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh +++ b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh @@ -30,6 +30,32 @@ ptxd_template_read() { export "${2}" } export -f ptxd_template_read +# +# Read a variable from user input, limited to an array of options +# +# $1 prompt prefix +# $2 variable name +# $3..$n options +# +ptxd_template_read_options() { + local -a options=("${@:3}") + local i=1 + echo "${PTXDIST_LOG_PROMPT}select option by number:" + for option in "${options[@]}"; do + echo "${PTXDIST_LOG_PROMPT}[${i}] ${option}" + ((i++)) + done + while : ; do + ptxd_template_read "${1}" chosen + [ -n "${chosen}" ] && [ "${chosen}" -gt 0 ] && + [ "${chosen}" -le "${#options[@]}" ] && + break + + echo "${PTXDIST_LOG_PROMPT}invalid option" + done + export "${2}=${options[$chosen-1]}" +} +export -f ptxd_template_read_options ptxd_template_read_name() { ptxd_template_read "enter package name" package_name -- 2.27.0 _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* Re: [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 1/6] ptxd_lib_template: add ptxd_template_read_options 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 1/6] ptxd_lib_template: add ptxd_template_read_options Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-19 6:24 ` Michael Olbrich 2020-06-19 8:13 ` Bastian Krause 2020-06-19 22:04 ` [ptxdist] [APPLIED] " Michael Olbrich 1 sibling, 1 reply; 24+ messages in thread From: Michael Olbrich @ 2020-06-19 6:24 UTC (permalink / raw) To: ptxdist On Wed, Jun 17, 2020 at 04:31:20PM +0200, Bastian Krause wrote: > Read a variable from user input, limited to a set of options. > > Example: > > $ ptxd_template_read_options "select your option" TYPE "option A" "option B" "option C" > ptxdist: select option by number: > ptxdist: [1] option A > ptxdist: [2] option B > ptxdist: [3] option C > ptxdist: select your option................: 2 > $ echo $TYPE > option B > > The user can select 1, 2 or 3. Other input is not accepted. > > Signed-off-by: Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> > --- > Introduced in v3. Used to ask user about HSM type in a later commit. > --- > scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh | 26 ++++++++++++++++++++++++++ > 1 file changed, 26 insertions(+) > > diff --git a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh > index f39e6e033..6b405763b 100644 > --- a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh > +++ b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh > @@ -30,6 +30,32 @@ ptxd_template_read() { > export "${2}" > } > export -f ptxd_template_read > +# > +# Read a variable from user input, limited to an array of options > +# > +# $1 prompt prefix > +# $2 variable name > +# $3..$n options > +# > +ptxd_template_read_options() { > + local -a options=("${@:3}") > + local i=1 > + echo "${PTXDIST_LOG_PROMPT}select option by number:" > + for option in "${options[@]}"; do > + echo "${PTXDIST_LOG_PROMPT}[${i}] ${option}" > + ((i++)) > + done > + while : ; do > + ptxd_template_read "${1}" chosen > + [ -n "${chosen}" ] && [ "${chosen}" -gt 0 ] && > + [ "${chosen}" -le "${#options[@]}" ] && > + break > + > + echo "${PTXDIST_LOG_PROMPT}invalid option" > + done > + export "${2}=${options[$chosen-1]}" Wrong indention. I'll fix it when I apply this. Michael > +} > +export -f ptxd_template_read_options > > ptxd_template_read_name() { > ptxd_template_read "enter package name" package_name > -- > 2.27.0 > > > _______________________________________________ > ptxdist mailing list > ptxdist@pengutronix.de > To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de > -- Pengutronix e.K. | | Steuerwalder Str. 21 | http://www.pengutronix.de/ | 31137 Hildesheim, Germany | Phone: +49-5121-206917-0 | Amtsgericht Hildesheim, HRA 2686 | Fax: +49-5121-206917-5555 | _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* Re: [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 1/6] ptxd_lib_template: add ptxd_template_read_options 2020-06-19 6:24 ` Michael Olbrich @ 2020-06-19 8:13 ` Bastian Krause 0 siblings, 0 replies; 24+ messages in thread From: Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-19 8:13 UTC (permalink / raw) To: ptxdist On 6/19/20 8:24 AM, Michael Olbrich wrote: > On Wed, Jun 17, 2020 at 04:31:20PM +0200, Bastian Krause wrote: >> Read a variable from user input, limited to a set of options. >> >> Example: >> >> $ ptxd_template_read_options "select your option" TYPE "option A" "option B" "option C" >> ptxdist: select option by number: >> ptxdist: [1] option A >> ptxdist: [2] option B >> ptxdist: [3] option C >> ptxdist: select your option................: 2 >> $ echo $TYPE >> option B >> >> The user can select 1, 2 or 3. Other input is not accepted. >> >> Signed-off-by: Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> >> --- >> Introduced in v3. Used to ask user about HSM type in a later commit. >> --- >> scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh | 26 ++++++++++++++++++++++++++ >> 1 file changed, 26 insertions(+) >> >> diff --git a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh >> index f39e6e033..6b405763b 100644 >> --- a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh >> +++ b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh >> @@ -30,6 +30,32 @@ ptxd_template_read() { >> export "${2}" >> } >> export -f ptxd_template_read >> +# >> +# Read a variable from user input, limited to an array of options >> +# >> +# $1 prompt prefix >> +# $2 variable name >> +# $3..$n options >> +# >> +ptxd_template_read_options() { >> + local -a options=("${@:3}") >> + local i=1 >> + echo "${PTXDIST_LOG_PROMPT}select option by number:" >> + for option in "${options[@]}"; do >> + echo "${PTXDIST_LOG_PROMPT}[${i}] ${option}" >> + ((i++)) >> + done >> + while : ; do >> + ptxd_template_read "${1}" chosen >> + [ -n "${chosen}" ] && [ "${chosen}" -gt 0 ] && >> + [ "${chosen}" -le "${#options[@]}" ] && >> + break >> + >> + echo "${PTXDIST_LOG_PROMPT}invalid option" >> + done >> + export "${2}=${options[$chosen-1]}" > > Wrong indention. I'll fix it when I apply this. Thanks! Regards, Bastian >> +} >> +export -f ptxd_template_read_options >> >> ptxd_template_read_name() { >> ptxd_template_read "enter package name" package_name >> -- >> 2.27.0 >> >> >> _______________________________________________ >> ptxdist mailing list >> ptxdist@pengutronix.de >> To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de >> > -- Pengutronix e.K. | | Steuerwalder Str. 21 | http://www.pengutronix.de/ | 31137 Hildesheim, Germany | Phone: +49-5121-206917-0 | Amtsgericht Hildesheim, HRA 2686 | Fax: +49-5121-206917-5555 | _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* Re: [ptxdist] [APPLIED] ptxd_lib_template: add ptxd_template_read_options 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 1/6] ptxd_lib_template: add ptxd_template_read_options Bastian Krause 2020-06-19 6:24 ` Michael Olbrich @ 2020-06-19 22:04 ` Michael Olbrich 1 sibling, 0 replies; 24+ messages in thread From: Michael Olbrich @ 2020-06-19 22:04 UTC (permalink / raw) To: ptxdist; +Cc: Bastian Krause Thanks, applied as bf1a401a968193cf8fd8ebc4a6f8c899c2c3bae3. Michael [sent from post-receive hook] On Sat, 20 Jun 2020 00:04:06 +0200, Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> wrote: > Read a variable from user input, limited to a set of options. > > Example: > > $ ptxd_template_read_options "select your option" TYPE "option A" "option B" "option C" > ptxdist: select option by number: > ptxdist: [1] option A > ptxdist: [2] option B > ptxdist: [3] option C > ptxdist: select your option................: 2 > $ echo $TYPE > option B > > The user can select 1, 2 or 3. Other input is not accepted. > > Signed-off-by: Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> > Message-Id: <20200617143125.23999-2-bst@pengutronix.de> > [mol: fix indention] > Signed-off-by: Michael Olbrich <m.olbrich@pengutronix.de> > > diff --git a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh > index 3d47cd85a4c4..9cace6c14a0b 100644 > --- a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh > +++ b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh > @@ -30,6 +30,32 @@ ptxd_template_read() { > export "${2}" > } > export -f ptxd_template_read > +# > +# Read a variable from user input, limited to an array of options > +# > +# $1 prompt prefix > +# $2 variable name > +# $3..$n options > +# > +ptxd_template_read_options() { > + local -a options=("${@:3}") > + local i=1 > + echo "${PTXDIST_LOG_PROMPT}select option by number:" > + for option in "${options[@]}"; do > + echo "${PTXDIST_LOG_PROMPT}[${i}] ${option}" > + ((i++)) > + done > + while : ; do > + ptxd_template_read "${1}" chosen > + [ -n "${chosen}" ] && [ "${chosen}" -gt 0 ] && > + [ "${chosen}" -le "${#options[@]}" ] && > + break > + > + echo "${PTXDIST_LOG_PROMPT}invalid option" > + done > + export "${2}=${options[$chosen-1]}" > +} > +export -f ptxd_template_read_options > > ptxd_template_read_name() { > ptxd_template_read "enter package name" package_name _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 2/6] package templates: add code-signing-provider template 2020-06-17 14:31 [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 0/6] Add code-signing-provider template, add code signing docs Bastian Krause 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 1/6] ptxd_lib_template: add ptxd_template_read_options Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-17 14:31 ` Bastian Krause 2020-06-18 11:40 ` Roland Hieber ` (3 more replies) 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 3/6] doc: dev_manual: split up into multiple files Bastian Krause ` (3 subsequent siblings) 5 siblings, 4 replies; 24+ messages in thread From: Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-17 14:31 UTC (permalink / raw) To: ptxdist; +Cc: Bastian Krause A ptxdist code signing provider is a package which selects the required host tools needed for the code signing helpers to work. A shell script is needed to define roles, set PKCS#11 URIs and import keys if SoftHSM is used. In order to simplify its creation provide a template along with an example script. Signed-off-by: Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> --- Changes since v2: - rename srk object name for consistency reasons - ask user about HSM type - split HSM/SoftHSM ptxdist-set-keys.sh cases into separate files - introduce wizard.sh to generate ptxdist-set-keys.sh HSM case specific - set dependencies HSM case specific - introduce pre rule template to extend CODE_SIGNING_ENV HSM case specific --- .../ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh | 42 ++++++++++++++ .../ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh | 58 +++++++++++++++++++ .../templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh | 10 ++++ .../template-code-signing-provider-choice-in | 5 ++ .../template-code-signing-provider-in | 14 +++++ .../template-code-signing-provider-make | 41 +++++++++++++ .../template-code-signing-provider-pre-make | 15 +++++ scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh | 31 ++++++++++ 8 files changed, 216 insertions(+) create mode 100755 rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh create mode 100755 rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh create mode 100644 rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make diff --git a/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh new file mode 100755 index 000000000..6bbe830f2 --- /dev/null +++ b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh @@ -0,0 +1,42 @@ +#!/bin/bash + +set -e + +set_fit_keys() { + local r="image-kernel-fit" + cs_define_role "${r}" + + # HSM use case + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=kernel-fit" +} + +set_rauc_keys() { + local r="update" + cs_define_role "${r}" + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=rauc" + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" +} + +set_imx_habv4_keys() { + # HSM use case, assuming it contains only 1st CSF/IMG key + for i in 1 2 3 4; do + r="imx-habv4-srk${i}" + cs_define_role "${r}" + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=srk${i}" + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" + done + + r="imx-habv4-csf1" + cs_define_role ${r} + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=csf1" + + r="imx-habv4-img1" + cs_define_role ${r} + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=img1" +} + + +# HSM use case +set_fit_keys +set_rauc_keys +set_imx_habv4_keys diff --git a/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh new file mode 100755 index 000000000..0836d61d1 --- /dev/null +++ b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh @@ -0,0 +1,58 @@ +#!/bin/bash + +set -e + +import_fit_keys() { + local fit_cert_dir=fit + local r="image-kernel-fit" + cs_define_role "${r}" + + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${fit_cert_dir}/fit-4096-development.crt" + cs_import_pubkey_from_pem "${r}" "${fit_cert_dir}/fit-4096-development.key" + cs_import_privkey_from_pem "${r}" "${fit_cert_dir}/fit-4096-development.key" +} + +import_rauc_keys() { + local rauc_cert_dir=rauc + local r="update" + cs_define_role "${r}" + + # SoftHSM use case + cs_import_cert_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.cert.pem" + cs_import_pubkey_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.key.pem" + cs_import_privkey_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.key.pem" + + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" +} + +import_imx_habv4_keys() { + local imx_habv4_key_dir="habv4" + local crts="${imx_habv4_key_dir}/crts" + local keys="${imx_habv4_key_dir}/keys" + local OPENSSL_KEYPASS="${imx_habv4_key_dir}/keys/key_pass.txt" + + for i in 1 2 3 4; do + r="imx-habv4-srk${i}" + cs_define_role "${r}" + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${crts}/SRK${i}_sha256_4096_65537_v3_ca_crt.der" + cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${keys}/SRK${i}_sha256_4096_65537_v3_ca_key.pem" + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" + + r="imx-habv4-csf${i}" + cs_define_role "${r}" + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${crts}/CSF${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_crt.der" + cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${keys}/CSF${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_key.pem" + + r="imx-habv4-img${i}" + cs_define_role "${r}" + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${crts}/IMG${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_crt.der" + cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${keys}/IMG${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_key.pem" + done +} + + +# SoftHSM use case +cs_init_softhsm +import_fit_keys +import_rauc_keys +import_imx_habv4_keys diff --git a/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh new file mode 100644 index 000000000..83d6d54e3 --- /dev/null +++ b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh @@ -0,0 +1,10 @@ +#!/bin/bash + +if [ "$TYPE" = "SoftHSM" ]; then + mv ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh ptxdist-set-keys.sh + rm ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh + +elif [ "$TYPE" = "HSM with OpenSC support" ] || [ "$TYPE" = "other HSM" ]; then + mv ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh ptxdist-set-keys.sh + rm ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh +fi diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in new file mode 100644 index 000000000..e2108f870 --- /dev/null +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in @@ -0,0 +1,5 @@ +## SECTION=code_signing_provider + +config CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ + bool + prompt "@package@" diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in new file mode 100644 index 000000000..b84ba839c --- /dev/null +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in @@ -0,0 +1,14 @@ +## SECTION=code_signing + +config CODE_SIGNING + select HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING if CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ + +config CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER + default "@package@" if CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ + +config HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING + bool + select HOST_LIBP11 + select HOST_OPENSSL + select HOST_EXTRACT_CERT + @EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES@ diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make new file mode 100644 index 000000000..94830d92e --- /dev/null +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make @@ -0,0 +1,41 @@ +# -*-makefile-*- +# +# Copyright (C) @YEAR@ by @AUTHOR@ +# +# For further information about the PTXdist project and license conditions +# see the README file. +# + +# +# We provide this package +# +HOST_PACKAGES-$(PTXCONF_HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING) += host-@package@-code-signing + +# +# Paths and names +# +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_VERSION := @VERSION@ +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING := @package@-code-signing-$(HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_VERSION) +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_URL := file://local_src/@package@-code-signing +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_DIR := $(HOST_BUILDDIR)/$(HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING) + +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_CONF_TOOL := NO + +# ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- +# Compile +# ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_MAKE_ENV := \ + $(CODE_SIGNING_ENV) + +$(STATEDIR)/host-@package@-code-signing.compile: + @$(call targetinfo) + @$(call world/execute, HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING, \ + ./ptxdist-set-keys.sh) + @$(call touch) + +$(STATEDIR)/host-@package@-code-signing.install: + @$(call targetinfo) + @$(call touch) + +# vim: syntax=make diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make new file mode 100644 index 000000000..28cac750c --- /dev/null +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make @@ -0,0 +1,15 @@ +# -*-makefile-*- +# +# Copyright (C) @YEAR@ by @AUTHOR@ +# +# For further information about the PTXdist project and license conditions +# see the README file. +# + +ifndef PTXCONF_CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ +CODE_SIGNING_ENV += \ + PKCS11_MODULE_PATH=@MODULE_PATH@ + $(HSM_CODE_SIGNING_ENV) +endif + +# vim: syntax=make diff --git a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh index 6b405763b..805d8d9d3 100644 --- a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh +++ b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh @@ -486,3 +486,34 @@ ptxd_template_new_blspec_entry() { export -f ptxd_template_new_blspec_entry ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="blspec-entry" ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="create package for a bootloader spec entry" + +ptxd_template_new_code_signing_provider() { + export class="host-" + ptxd_template_read_basic && + ptxd_template_read_author && + ptxd_template_read_options "provider type" TYPE "SoftHSM" "HSM with OpenSC support" "other HSM" + package_filename="${package_filename}-code-signing" + local template_file="$(ptxd_template_file "${template}-choice-in")" + local filename="${PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR}/platforms/${class}${package_filename}-choice.in" + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" + template_file="$(ptxd_template_file "${template}-pre-make")" + filename="${PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR}/rules/pre/020-${package_filename}-hsm.make" + if [ "$TYPE" = "SoftHSM" ]; then + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select HOST_SOFTHSM" + elif [ "$TYPE" = "HSM with OpenSC support" ]; then + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select HOST_OPENSC + select HOST_OPENSC_PCSC" + export MODULE_PATH="\${PTXDIST_SYSROOT_HOST}/lib/pkcs11/opensc-pkcs11.so" + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" + elif [ "$TYPE" = "other HSM" ]; then + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select FIXME" + export MODULE_PATH="\${PTXDIST_SYSROOT_HOST}/fix/me" + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" + fi + ptxd_template_write_platform_rules + package="${package}-code-signing" + ptxd_template_write_src +} +export -f ptxd_template_new_code_signing_provider +ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="code-signing-provider" +ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="create package for a code signing provider" -- 2.27.0 _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* Re: [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 2/6] package templates: add code-signing-provider template 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 2/6] package templates: add code-signing-provider template Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-18 11:40 ` Roland Hieber 2020-06-18 11:50 ` Bastian Krause 2020-06-19 6:28 ` Michael Olbrich ` (2 subsequent siblings) 3 siblings, 1 reply; 24+ messages in thread From: Roland Hieber @ 2020-06-18 11:40 UTC (permalink / raw) To: Bastian Krause; +Cc: ptxdist On Wed, Jun 17, 2020 at 04:31:21PM +0200, Bastian Krause wrote: > A ptxdist code signing provider is a package which selects the required > host tools needed for the code signing helpers to work. A shell script > is needed to define roles, set PKCS#11 URIs and import keys if SoftHSM > is used. In order to simplify its creation provide a template along with > an example script. > > Signed-off-by: Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> > --- > Changes since v2: > - rename srk object name for consistency reasons > - ask user about HSM type > - split HSM/SoftHSM ptxdist-set-keys.sh cases into separate files > - introduce wizard.sh to generate ptxdist-set-keys.sh HSM case specific > - set dependencies HSM case specific > - introduce pre rule template to extend CODE_SIGNING_ENV HSM case > specific > --- > .../ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh | 42 ++++++++++++++ > .../ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh | 58 +++++++++++++++++++ > .../templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh | 10 ++++ > .../template-code-signing-provider-choice-in | 5 ++ > .../template-code-signing-provider-in | 14 +++++ > .../template-code-signing-provider-make | 41 +++++++++++++ > .../template-code-signing-provider-pre-make | 15 +++++ > scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh | 31 ++++++++++ > 8 files changed, 216 insertions(+) > create mode 100755 rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh > create mode 100755 rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh > create mode 100644 rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh > create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in > create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in > create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make > create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make > > diff --git a/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh > new file mode 100755 > index 000000000..6bbe830f2 > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh > @@ -0,0 +1,42 @@ > +#!/bin/bash > + > +set -e > + > +set_fit_keys() { > + local r="image-kernel-fit" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + > + # HSM use case > + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=kernel-fit" > +} > + > +set_rauc_keys() { > + local r="update" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=rauc" > + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" > +} > + > +set_imx_habv4_keys() { > + # HSM use case, assuming it contains only 1st CSF/IMG key > + for i in 1 2 3 4; do > + r="imx-habv4-srk${i}" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=srk${i}" > + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" > + done > + > + r="imx-habv4-csf1" > + cs_define_role ${r} > + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=csf1" > + > + r="imx-habv4-img1" > + cs_define_role ${r} > + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=img1" > +} > + > + > +# HSM use case > +set_fit_keys > +set_rauc_keys > +set_imx_habv4_keys > diff --git a/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh > new file mode 100755 > index 000000000..0836d61d1 > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh > @@ -0,0 +1,58 @@ > +#!/bin/bash > + > +set -e > + > +import_fit_keys() { > + local fit_cert_dir=fit > + local r="image-kernel-fit" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + > + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${fit_cert_dir}/fit-4096-development.crt" > + cs_import_pubkey_from_pem "${r}" "${fit_cert_dir}/fit-4096-development.key" > + cs_import_privkey_from_pem "${r}" "${fit_cert_dir}/fit-4096-development.key" > +} > + > +import_rauc_keys() { > + local rauc_cert_dir=rauc > + local r="update" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + > + # SoftHSM use case > + cs_import_cert_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.cert.pem" > + cs_import_pubkey_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.key.pem" > + cs_import_privkey_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.key.pem" > + > + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" > +} > + > +import_imx_habv4_keys() { > + local imx_habv4_key_dir="habv4" > + local crts="${imx_habv4_key_dir}/crts" > + local keys="${imx_habv4_key_dir}/keys" > + local OPENSSL_KEYPASS="${imx_habv4_key_dir}/keys/key_pass.txt" > + > + for i in 1 2 3 4; do > + r="imx-habv4-srk${i}" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${crts}/SRK${i}_sha256_4096_65537_v3_ca_crt.der" > + cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${keys}/SRK${i}_sha256_4096_65537_v3_ca_key.pem" > + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" > + > + r="imx-habv4-csf${i}" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${crts}/CSF${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_crt.der" > + cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${keys}/CSF${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_key.pem" > + > + r="imx-habv4-img${i}" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${crts}/IMG${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_crt.der" > + cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${keys}/IMG${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_key.pem" > + done > +} > + > + > +# SoftHSM use case > +cs_init_softhsm > +import_fit_keys > +import_rauc_keys > +import_imx_habv4_keys > diff --git a/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000..83d6d54e3 > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh > @@ -0,0 +1,10 @@ > +#!/bin/bash > + > +if [ "$TYPE" = "SoftHSM" ]; then > + mv ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh ptxdist-set-keys.sh > + rm ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh > + > +elif [ "$TYPE" = "HSM with OpenSC support" ] || [ "$TYPE" = "other HSM" ]; then > + mv ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh ptxdist-set-keys.sh > + rm ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh > +fi > diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000..e2108f870 > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in > @@ -0,0 +1,5 @@ > +## SECTION=code_signing_provider > + > +config CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ > + bool > + prompt "@package@" > diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000..b84ba839c > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in > @@ -0,0 +1,14 @@ > +## SECTION=code_signing > + > +config CODE_SIGNING > + select HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING if CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ > + > +config CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER > + default "@package@" if CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ > + > +config HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING > + bool > + select HOST_LIBP11 > + select HOST_OPENSSL > + select HOST_EXTRACT_CERT > + @EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES@ > diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000..94830d92e > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make > @@ -0,0 +1,41 @@ > +# -*-makefile-*- > +# > +# Copyright (C) @YEAR@ by @AUTHOR@ > +# > +# For further information about the PTXdist project and license conditions > +# see the README file. > +# > + > +# > +# We provide this package > +# > +HOST_PACKAGES-$(PTXCONF_HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING) += host-@package@-code-signing > + > +# > +# Paths and names > +# > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_VERSION := @VERSION@ > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING := @package@-code-signing-$(HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_VERSION) > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_URL := file://local_src/@package@-code-signing > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_DIR := $(HOST_BUILDDIR)/$(HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING) > + > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_CONF_TOOL := NO > + > +# ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- > +# Compile > +# ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- > + > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_MAKE_ENV := \ > + $(CODE_SIGNING_ENV) > + > +$(STATEDIR)/host-@package@-code-signing.compile: > + @$(call targetinfo) > + @$(call world/execute, HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING, \ > + ./ptxdist-set-keys.sh) > + @$(call touch) > + > +$(STATEDIR)/host-@package@-code-signing.install: > + @$(call targetinfo) > + @$(call touch) > + > +# vim: syntax=make > diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000..28cac750c > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make > @@ -0,0 +1,15 @@ > +# -*-makefile-*- > +# > +# Copyright (C) @YEAR@ by @AUTHOR@ > +# > +# For further information about the PTXdist project and license conditions > +# see the README file. > +# > + > +ifndef PTXCONF_CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ > +CODE_SIGNING_ENV += \ > + PKCS11_MODULE_PATH=@MODULE_PATH@ > + $(HSM_CODE_SIGNING_ENV) > +endif > + > +# vim: syntax=make > diff --git a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh > index 6b405763b..805d8d9d3 100644 > --- a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh > +++ b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh > @@ -486,3 +486,34 @@ ptxd_template_new_blspec_entry() { > export -f ptxd_template_new_blspec_entry > ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="blspec-entry" > ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="create package for a bootloader spec entry" > + > +ptxd_template_new_code_signing_provider() { > + export class="host-" > + ptxd_template_read_basic && > + ptxd_template_read_author && > + ptxd_template_read_options "provider type" TYPE "SoftHSM" "HSM with OpenSC support" "other HSM" > + package_filename="${package_filename}-code-signing" > + local template_file="$(ptxd_template_file "${template}-choice-in")" > + local filename="${PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR}/platforms/${class}${package_filename}-choice.in" > + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" > + template_file="$(ptxd_template_file "${template}-pre-make")" > + filename="${PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR}/rules/pre/020-${package_filename}-hsm.make" > + if [ "$TYPE" = "SoftHSM" ]; then > + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select HOST_SOFTHSM" > + elif [ "$TYPE" = "HSM with OpenSC support" ]; then > + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select HOST_OPENSC > + select HOST_OPENSC_PCSC" > + export MODULE_PATH="\${PTXDIST_SYSROOT_HOST}/lib/pkcs11/opensc-pkcs11.so" > + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" > + elif [ "$TYPE" = "other HSM" ]; then > + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select FIXME" > + export MODULE_PATH="\${PTXDIST_SYSROOT_HOST}/fix/me" > + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" Hmm, the indentation is off here (tabs mixed with spaces), but that's the case for the whole file, so I guess that's okay :D Tested-by: Roland Hieber <rhi@pengutronix.de> Reviewed-by: Roland Hieber <rhi@pengutronix.de> - Roland > + fi > + ptxd_template_write_platform_rules > + package="${package}-code-signing" > + ptxd_template_write_src > +} > +export -f ptxd_template_new_code_signing_provider > +ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="code-signing-provider" > +ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="create package for a code signing provider" > -- > 2.27.0 > > > _______________________________________________ > ptxdist mailing list > ptxdist@pengutronix.de > To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de > -- Roland Hieber, Pengutronix e.K. | r.hieber@pengutronix.de | Steuerwalder Str. 21 | https://www.pengutronix.de/ | 31137 Hildesheim, Germany | Phone: +49-5121-206917-0 | Amtsgericht Hildesheim, HRA 2686 | Fax: +49-5121-206917-5555 | _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* Re: [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 2/6] package templates: add code-signing-provider template 2020-06-18 11:40 ` Roland Hieber @ 2020-06-18 11:50 ` Bastian Krause 2020-06-19 6:12 ` Michael Olbrich 0 siblings, 1 reply; 24+ messages in thread From: Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-18 11:50 UTC (permalink / raw) To: Roland Hieber; +Cc: ptxdist On 6/18/20 1:40 PM, Roland Hieber wrote: > On Wed, Jun 17, 2020 at 04:31:21PM +0200, Bastian Krause wrote: >> A ptxdist code signing provider is a package which selects the required >> host tools needed for the code signing helpers to work. A shell script >> is needed to define roles, set PKCS#11 URIs and import keys if SoftHSM >> is used. In order to simplify its creation provide a template along with >> an example script. >> >> Signed-off-by: Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> >> --- >> Changes since v2: >> - rename srk object name for consistency reasons >> - ask user about HSM type >> - split HSM/SoftHSM ptxdist-set-keys.sh cases into separate files >> - introduce wizard.sh to generate ptxdist-set-keys.sh HSM case specific >> - set dependencies HSM case specific >> - introduce pre rule template to extend CODE_SIGNING_ENV HSM case >> specific >> --- >> .../ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh | 42 ++++++++++++++ >> .../ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh | 58 +++++++++++++++++++ >> .../templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh | 10 ++++ >> .../template-code-signing-provider-choice-in | 5 ++ >> .../template-code-signing-provider-in | 14 +++++ >> .../template-code-signing-provider-make | 41 +++++++++++++ >> .../template-code-signing-provider-pre-make | 15 +++++ >> scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh | 31 ++++++++++ >> 8 files changed, 216 insertions(+) >> create mode 100755 rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh >> create mode 100755 rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh >> create mode 100644 rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh >> create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in >> create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in >> create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make >> create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make >> >> diff --git a/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh >> new file mode 100755 >> index 000000000..6bbe830f2 >> --- /dev/null >> +++ b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh >> @@ -0,0 +1,42 @@ >> +#!/bin/bash >> + >> +set -e >> + >> +set_fit_keys() { >> + local r="image-kernel-fit" >> + cs_define_role "${r}" >> + >> + # HSM use case >> + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=kernel-fit" >> +} >> + >> +set_rauc_keys() { >> + local r="update" >> + cs_define_role "${r}" >> + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=rauc" >> + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" >> +} >> + >> +set_imx_habv4_keys() { >> + # HSM use case, assuming it contains only 1st CSF/IMG key >> + for i in 1 2 3 4; do >> + r="imx-habv4-srk${i}" >> + cs_define_role "${r}" >> + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=srk${i}" >> + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" >> + done >> + >> + r="imx-habv4-csf1" >> + cs_define_role ${r} >> + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=csf1" >> + >> + r="imx-habv4-img1" >> + cs_define_role ${r} >> + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=img1" >> +} >> + >> + >> +# HSM use case >> +set_fit_keys >> +set_rauc_keys >> +set_imx_habv4_keys >> diff --git a/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh >> new file mode 100755 >> index 000000000..0836d61d1 >> --- /dev/null >> +++ b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh >> @@ -0,0 +1,58 @@ >> +#!/bin/bash >> + >> +set -e >> + >> +import_fit_keys() { >> + local fit_cert_dir=fit >> + local r="image-kernel-fit" >> + cs_define_role "${r}" >> + >> + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${fit_cert_dir}/fit-4096-development.crt" >> + cs_import_pubkey_from_pem "${r}" "${fit_cert_dir}/fit-4096-development.key" >> + cs_import_privkey_from_pem "${r}" "${fit_cert_dir}/fit-4096-development.key" >> +} >> + >> +import_rauc_keys() { >> + local rauc_cert_dir=rauc >> + local r="update" >> + cs_define_role "${r}" >> + >> + # SoftHSM use case >> + cs_import_cert_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.cert.pem" >> + cs_import_pubkey_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.key.pem" >> + cs_import_privkey_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.key.pem" >> + >> + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" >> +} >> + >> +import_imx_habv4_keys() { >> + local imx_habv4_key_dir="habv4" >> + local crts="${imx_habv4_key_dir}/crts" >> + local keys="${imx_habv4_key_dir}/keys" >> + local OPENSSL_KEYPASS="${imx_habv4_key_dir}/keys/key_pass.txt" >> + >> + for i in 1 2 3 4; do >> + r="imx-habv4-srk${i}" >> + cs_define_role "${r}" >> + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${crts}/SRK${i}_sha256_4096_65537_v3_ca_crt.der" >> + cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${keys}/SRK${i}_sha256_4096_65537_v3_ca_key.pem" >> + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" >> + >> + r="imx-habv4-csf${i}" >> + cs_define_role "${r}" >> + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${crts}/CSF${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_crt.der" >> + cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${keys}/CSF${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_key.pem" >> + >> + r="imx-habv4-img${i}" >> + cs_define_role "${r}" >> + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${crts}/IMG${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_crt.der" >> + cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${keys}/IMG${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_key.pem" >> + done >> +} >> + >> + >> +# SoftHSM use case >> +cs_init_softhsm >> +import_fit_keys >> +import_rauc_keys >> +import_imx_habv4_keys >> diff --git a/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh >> new file mode 100644 >> index 000000000..83d6d54e3 >> --- /dev/null >> +++ b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh >> @@ -0,0 +1,10 @@ >> +#!/bin/bash >> + >> +if [ "$TYPE" = "SoftHSM" ]; then >> + mv ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh ptxdist-set-keys.sh >> + rm ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh >> + >> +elif [ "$TYPE" = "HSM with OpenSC support" ] || [ "$TYPE" = "other HSM" ]; then >> + mv ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh ptxdist-set-keys.sh >> + rm ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh >> +fi >> diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in >> new file mode 100644 >> index 000000000..e2108f870 >> --- /dev/null >> +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in >> @@ -0,0 +1,5 @@ >> +## SECTION=code_signing_provider >> + >> +config CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ >> + bool >> + prompt "@package@" >> diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in >> new file mode 100644 >> index 000000000..b84ba839c >> --- /dev/null >> +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in >> @@ -0,0 +1,14 @@ >> +## SECTION=code_signing >> + >> +config CODE_SIGNING >> + select HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING if CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ >> + >> +config CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER >> + default "@package@" if CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ >> + >> +config HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING >> + bool >> + select HOST_LIBP11 >> + select HOST_OPENSSL >> + select HOST_EXTRACT_CERT >> + @EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES@ >> diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make >> new file mode 100644 >> index 000000000..94830d92e >> --- /dev/null >> +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make >> @@ -0,0 +1,41 @@ >> +# -*-makefile-*- >> +# >> +# Copyright (C) @YEAR@ by @AUTHOR@ >> +# >> +# For further information about the PTXdist project and license conditions >> +# see the README file. >> +# >> + >> +# >> +# We provide this package >> +# >> +HOST_PACKAGES-$(PTXCONF_HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING) += host-@package@-code-signing >> + >> +# >> +# Paths and names >> +# >> +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_VERSION := @VERSION@ >> +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING := @package@-code-signing-$(HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_VERSION) >> +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_URL := file://local_src/@package@-code-signing >> +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_DIR := $(HOST_BUILDDIR)/$(HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING) >> + >> +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_CONF_TOOL := NO >> + >> +# ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- >> +# Compile >> +# ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- >> + >> +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_MAKE_ENV := \ >> + $(CODE_SIGNING_ENV) >> + >> +$(STATEDIR)/host-@package@-code-signing.compile: >> + @$(call targetinfo) >> + @$(call world/execute, HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING, \ >> + ./ptxdist-set-keys.sh) >> + @$(call touch) >> + >> +$(STATEDIR)/host-@package@-code-signing.install: >> + @$(call targetinfo) >> + @$(call touch) >> + >> +# vim: syntax=make >> diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make >> new file mode 100644 >> index 000000000..28cac750c >> --- /dev/null >> +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make >> @@ -0,0 +1,15 @@ >> +# -*-makefile-*- >> +# >> +# Copyright (C) @YEAR@ by @AUTHOR@ >> +# >> +# For further information about the PTXdist project and license conditions >> +# see the README file. >> +# >> + >> +ifndef PTXCONF_CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ >> +CODE_SIGNING_ENV += \ >> + PKCS11_MODULE_PATH=@MODULE_PATH@ >> + $(HSM_CODE_SIGNING_ENV) >> +endif >> + >> +# vim: syntax=make >> diff --git a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh >> index 6b405763b..805d8d9d3 100644 >> --- a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh >> +++ b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh >> @@ -486,3 +486,34 @@ ptxd_template_new_blspec_entry() { >> export -f ptxd_template_new_blspec_entry >> ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="blspec-entry" >> ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="create package for a bootloader spec entry" >> + >> +ptxd_template_new_code_signing_provider() { >> + export class="host-" >> + ptxd_template_read_basic && >> + ptxd_template_read_author && >> + ptxd_template_read_options "provider type" TYPE "SoftHSM" "HSM with OpenSC support" "other HSM" >> + package_filename="${package_filename}-code-signing" >> + local template_file="$(ptxd_template_file "${template}-choice-in")" >> + local filename="${PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR}/platforms/${class}${package_filename}-choice.in" >> + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" >> + template_file="$(ptxd_template_file "${template}-pre-make")" >> + filename="${PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR}/rules/pre/020-${package_filename}-hsm.make" >> + if [ "$TYPE" = "SoftHSM" ]; then >> + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select HOST_SOFTHSM" >> + elif [ "$TYPE" = "HSM with OpenSC support" ]; then >> + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select HOST_OPENSC >> + select HOST_OPENSC_PCSC" >> + export MODULE_PATH="\${PTXDIST_SYSROOT_HOST}/lib/pkcs11/opensc-pkcs11.so" >> + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" >> + elif [ "$TYPE" = "other HSM" ]; then >> + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select FIXME" >> + export MODULE_PATH="\${PTXDIST_SYSROOT_HOST}/fix/me" >> + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" > > Hmm, the indentation is off here (tabs mixed with spaces), but that's > the case for the whole file, so I guess that's okay :D I think the rule is every indentation level is 4 spaces and every 8 spaces should be converted to 1 tab. > Tested-by: Roland Hieber <rhi@pengutronix.de> > Reviewed-by: Roland Hieber <rhi@pengutronix.de> Thanks! Regards, Bastian -- Pengutronix e.K. | | Steuerwalder Str. 21 | http://www.pengutronix.de/ | 31137 Hildesheim, Germany | Phone: +49-5121-206917-0 | Amtsgericht Hildesheim, HRA 2686 | Fax: +49-5121-206917-5555 | _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* Re: [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 2/6] package templates: add code-signing-provider template 2020-06-18 11:50 ` Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-19 6:12 ` Michael Olbrich 0 siblings, 0 replies; 24+ messages in thread From: Michael Olbrich @ 2020-06-19 6:12 UTC (permalink / raw) To: ptxdist; +Cc: Roland Hieber On Thu, Jun 18, 2020 at 01:50:18PM +0200, Bastian Krause wrote: > On 6/18/20 1:40 PM, Roland Hieber wrote: > > On Wed, Jun 17, 2020 at 04:31:21PM +0200, Bastian Krause wrote: > >> diff --git a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh > >> index 6b405763b..805d8d9d3 100644 > >> --- a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh > >> +++ b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh > >> @@ -486,3 +486,34 @@ ptxd_template_new_blspec_entry() { > >> export -f ptxd_template_new_blspec_entry > >> ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="blspec-entry" > >> ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="create package for a bootloader spec entry" > >> + > >> +ptxd_template_new_code_signing_provider() { > >> + export class="host-" > >> + ptxd_template_read_basic && > >> + ptxd_template_read_author && > >> + ptxd_template_read_options "provider type" TYPE "SoftHSM" "HSM with OpenSC support" "other HSM" > >> + package_filename="${package_filename}-code-signing" > >> + local template_file="$(ptxd_template_file "${template}-choice-in")" > >> + local filename="${PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR}/platforms/${class}${package_filename}-choice.in" > >> + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" > >> + template_file="$(ptxd_template_file "${template}-pre-make")" > >> + filename="${PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR}/rules/pre/020-${package_filename}-hsm.make" > >> + if [ "$TYPE" = "SoftHSM" ]; then > >> + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select HOST_SOFTHSM" > >> + elif [ "$TYPE" = "HSM with OpenSC support" ]; then > >> + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select HOST_OPENSC > >> + select HOST_OPENSC_PCSC" > >> + export MODULE_PATH="\${PTXDIST_SYSROOT_HOST}/lib/pkcs11/opensc-pkcs11.so" > >> + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" > >> + elif [ "$TYPE" = "other HSM" ]; then > >> + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select FIXME" > >> + export MODULE_PATH="\${PTXDIST_SYSROOT_HOST}/fix/me" > >> + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" > > > > Hmm, the indentation is off here (tabs mixed with spaces), but that's > > the case for the whole file, so I guess that's okay :D > > I think the rule is every indentation level is 4 spaces and every 8 > spaces should be converted to 1 tab. Indeed. I think it's some emacs style indention. It's been driving me crazy for years but the scripts started that way and I never had a good reason to change it... Michael > > Tested-by: Roland Hieber <rhi@pengutronix.de> > > Reviewed-by: Roland Hieber <rhi@pengutronix.de> > > Thanks! > > Regards, > Bastian > > -- > Pengutronix e.K. | | > Steuerwalder Str. 21 | http://www.pengutronix.de/ | > 31137 Hildesheim, Germany | Phone: +49-5121-206917-0 | > Amtsgericht Hildesheim, HRA 2686 | Fax: +49-5121-206917-5555 | > > _______________________________________________ > ptxdist mailing list > ptxdist@pengutronix.de > To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de > -- Pengutronix e.K. | | Steuerwalder Str. 21 | http://www.pengutronix.de/ | 31137 Hildesheim, Germany | Phone: +49-5121-206917-0 | Amtsgericht Hildesheim, HRA 2686 | Fax: +49-5121-206917-5555 | _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* Re: [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 2/6] package templates: add code-signing-provider template 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 2/6] package templates: add code-signing-provider template Bastian Krause 2020-06-18 11:40 ` Roland Hieber @ 2020-06-19 6:28 ` Michael Olbrich 2020-06-19 7:52 ` Bastian Krause 2020-06-19 22:04 ` [ptxdist] [APPLIED] " Michael Olbrich 2020-09-24 10:04 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 2/6] " Ladislav Michl 3 siblings, 1 reply; 24+ messages in thread From: Michael Olbrich @ 2020-06-19 6:28 UTC (permalink / raw) To: ptxdist; +Cc: Bastian Krause On Wed, Jun 17, 2020 at 04:31:21PM +0200, Bastian Krause wrote: > A ptxdist code signing provider is a package which selects the required > host tools needed for the code signing helpers to work. A shell script > is needed to define roles, set PKCS#11 URIs and import keys if SoftHSM > is used. In order to simplify its creation provide a template along with > an example script. > > Signed-off-by: Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> > --- > Changes since v2: > - rename srk object name for consistency reasons > - ask user about HSM type > - split HSM/SoftHSM ptxdist-set-keys.sh cases into separate files > - introduce wizard.sh to generate ptxdist-set-keys.sh HSM case specific > - set dependencies HSM case specific > - introduce pre rule template to extend CODE_SIGNING_ENV HSM case > specific > --- > .../ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh | 42 ++++++++++++++ > .../ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh | 58 +++++++++++++++++++ > .../templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh | 10 ++++ > .../template-code-signing-provider-choice-in | 5 ++ > .../template-code-signing-provider-in | 14 +++++ > .../template-code-signing-provider-make | 41 +++++++++++++ > .../template-code-signing-provider-pre-make | 15 +++++ > scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh | 31 ++++++++++ > 8 files changed, 216 insertions(+) > create mode 100755 rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh > create mode 100755 rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh > create mode 100644 rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh > create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in > create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in > create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make > create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make > > diff --git a/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh > new file mode 100755 > index 000000000..6bbe830f2 > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh > @@ -0,0 +1,42 @@ > +#!/bin/bash > + > +set -e > + > +set_fit_keys() { > + local r="image-kernel-fit" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + > + # HSM use case > + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=kernel-fit" > +} > + > +set_rauc_keys() { > + local r="update" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=rauc" > + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" > +} > + > +set_imx_habv4_keys() { > + # HSM use case, assuming it contains only 1st CSF/IMG key > + for i in 1 2 3 4; do > + r="imx-habv4-srk${i}" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=srk${i}" > + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" > + done > + > + r="imx-habv4-csf1" > + cs_define_role ${r} > + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=csf1" > + > + r="imx-habv4-img1" > + cs_define_role ${r} > + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=img1" > +} > + > + > +# HSM use case > +set_fit_keys > +set_rauc_keys > +set_imx_habv4_keys > diff --git a/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh > new file mode 100755 > index 000000000..0836d61d1 > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh > @@ -0,0 +1,58 @@ > +#!/bin/bash > + > +set -e > + > +import_fit_keys() { > + local fit_cert_dir=fit > + local r="image-kernel-fit" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + > + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${fit_cert_dir}/fit-4096-development.crt" > + cs_import_pubkey_from_pem "${r}" "${fit_cert_dir}/fit-4096-development.key" > + cs_import_privkey_from_pem "${r}" "${fit_cert_dir}/fit-4096-development.key" > +} > + > +import_rauc_keys() { > + local rauc_cert_dir=rauc > + local r="update" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + > + # SoftHSM use case > + cs_import_cert_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.cert.pem" > + cs_import_pubkey_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.key.pem" > + cs_import_privkey_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.key.pem" > + > + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" > +} > + > +import_imx_habv4_keys() { > + local imx_habv4_key_dir="habv4" > + local crts="${imx_habv4_key_dir}/crts" > + local keys="${imx_habv4_key_dir}/keys" > + local OPENSSL_KEYPASS="${imx_habv4_key_dir}/keys/key_pass.txt" > + > + for i in 1 2 3 4; do > + r="imx-habv4-srk${i}" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${crts}/SRK${i}_sha256_4096_65537_v3_ca_crt.der" > + cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${keys}/SRK${i}_sha256_4096_65537_v3_ca_key.pem" > + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" > + > + r="imx-habv4-csf${i}" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${crts}/CSF${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_crt.der" > + cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${keys}/CSF${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_key.pem" > + > + r="imx-habv4-img${i}" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${crts}/IMG${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_crt.der" > + cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${keys}/IMG${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_key.pem" > + done > +} > + > + > +# SoftHSM use case > +cs_init_softhsm > +import_fit_keys > +import_rauc_keys > +import_imx_habv4_keys > diff --git a/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000..83d6d54e3 > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh > @@ -0,0 +1,10 @@ > +#!/bin/bash > + > +if [ "$TYPE" = "SoftHSM" ]; then > + mv ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh ptxdist-set-keys.sh > + rm ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh > + > +elif [ "$TYPE" = "HSM with OpenSC support" ] || [ "$TYPE" = "other HSM" ]; then > + mv ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh ptxdist-set-keys.sh > + rm ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh > +fi > diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000..e2108f870 > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in > @@ -0,0 +1,5 @@ > +## SECTION=code_signing_provider > + > +config CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ > + bool > + prompt "@package@" > diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000..b84ba839c > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in > @@ -0,0 +1,14 @@ > +## SECTION=code_signing > + > +config CODE_SIGNING > + select HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING if CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ > + > +config CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER > + default "@package@" if CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ > + > +config HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING > + bool > + select HOST_LIBP11 > + select HOST_OPENSSL > + select HOST_EXTRACT_CERT > + @EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES@ > diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000..94830d92e > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make > @@ -0,0 +1,41 @@ > +# -*-makefile-*- > +# > +# Copyright (C) @YEAR@ by @AUTHOR@ > +# > +# For further information about the PTXdist project and license conditions > +# see the README file. > +# > + > +# > +# We provide this package > +# > +HOST_PACKAGES-$(PTXCONF_HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING) += host-@package@-code-signing > + > +# > +# Paths and names > +# > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_VERSION := @VERSION@ > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING := @package@-code-signing-$(HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_VERSION) > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_URL := file://local_src/@package@-code-signing > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_DIR := $(HOST_BUILDDIR)/$(HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING) > + > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_CONF_TOOL := NO > + > +# ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- > +# Compile > +# ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- > + > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_MAKE_ENV := \ > + $(CODE_SIGNING_ENV) > + > +$(STATEDIR)/host-@package@-code-signing.compile: > + @$(call targetinfo) > + @$(call world/execute, HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING, \ > + ./ptxdist-set-keys.sh) > + @$(call touch) > + > +$(STATEDIR)/host-@package@-code-signing.install: > + @$(call targetinfo) > + @$(call touch) > + > +# vim: syntax=make > diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000..28cac750c > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make > @@ -0,0 +1,15 @@ > +# -*-makefile-*- > +# > +# Copyright (C) @YEAR@ by @AUTHOR@ > +# > +# For further information about the PTXdist project and license conditions > +# see the README file. > +# > + > +ifndef PTXCONF_CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ > +CODE_SIGNING_ENV += \ > + PKCS11_MODULE_PATH=@MODULE_PATH@ > + $(HSM_CODE_SIGNING_ENV) This line has no effect. I removed it. In the OpenSC case, no extra env is needed and for other HSMs the file must be edited anyways and all need extra environment can be added. Michael > +endif > + > +# vim: syntax=make > diff --git a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh > index 6b405763b..805d8d9d3 100644 > --- a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh > +++ b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh > @@ -486,3 +486,34 @@ ptxd_template_new_blspec_entry() { > export -f ptxd_template_new_blspec_entry > ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="blspec-entry" > ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="create package for a bootloader spec entry" > + > +ptxd_template_new_code_signing_provider() { > + export class="host-" > + ptxd_template_read_basic && > + ptxd_template_read_author && > + ptxd_template_read_options "provider type" TYPE "SoftHSM" "HSM with OpenSC support" "other HSM" > + package_filename="${package_filename}-code-signing" > + local template_file="$(ptxd_template_file "${template}-choice-in")" > + local filename="${PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR}/platforms/${class}${package_filename}-choice.in" > + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" > + template_file="$(ptxd_template_file "${template}-pre-make")" > + filename="${PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR}/rules/pre/020-${package_filename}-hsm.make" > + if [ "$TYPE" = "SoftHSM" ]; then > + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select HOST_SOFTHSM" > + elif [ "$TYPE" = "HSM with OpenSC support" ]; then > + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select HOST_OPENSC > + select HOST_OPENSC_PCSC" > + export MODULE_PATH="\${PTXDIST_SYSROOT_HOST}/lib/pkcs11/opensc-pkcs11.so" > + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" > + elif [ "$TYPE" = "other HSM" ]; then > + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select FIXME" > + export MODULE_PATH="\${PTXDIST_SYSROOT_HOST}/fix/me" > + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" > + fi > + ptxd_template_write_platform_rules > + package="${package}-code-signing" > + ptxd_template_write_src > +} > +export -f ptxd_template_new_code_signing_provider > +ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="code-signing-provider" > +ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="create package for a code signing provider" > -- > 2.27.0 > > > _______________________________________________ > ptxdist mailing list > ptxdist@pengutronix.de > To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de > -- Pengutronix e.K. | | Steuerwalder Str. 21 | http://www.pengutronix.de/ | 31137 Hildesheim, Germany | Phone: +49-5121-206917-0 | Amtsgericht Hildesheim, HRA 2686 | Fax: +49-5121-206917-5555 | _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* Re: [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 2/6] package templates: add code-signing-provider template 2020-06-19 6:28 ` Michael Olbrich @ 2020-06-19 7:52 ` Bastian Krause 0 siblings, 0 replies; 24+ messages in thread From: Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-19 7:52 UTC (permalink / raw) To: ptxdist On 6/19/20 8:28 AM, Michael Olbrich wrote: > On Wed, Jun 17, 2020 at 04:31:21PM +0200, Bastian Krause wrote: >> A ptxdist code signing provider is a package which selects the required >> host tools needed for the code signing helpers to work. A shell script >> is needed to define roles, set PKCS#11 URIs and import keys if SoftHSM >> is used. In order to simplify its creation provide a template along with >> an example script. >> >> Signed-off-by: Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> >> --- >> Changes since v2: >> - rename srk object name for consistency reasons >> - ask user about HSM type >> - split HSM/SoftHSM ptxdist-set-keys.sh cases into separate files >> - introduce wizard.sh to generate ptxdist-set-keys.sh HSM case specific >> - set dependencies HSM case specific >> - introduce pre rule template to extend CODE_SIGNING_ENV HSM case >> specific >> --- >> .../ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh | 42 ++++++++++++++ >> .../ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh | 58 +++++++++++++++++++ >> .../templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh | 10 ++++ >> .../template-code-signing-provider-choice-in | 5 ++ >> .../template-code-signing-provider-in | 14 +++++ >> .../template-code-signing-provider-make | 41 +++++++++++++ >> .../template-code-signing-provider-pre-make | 15 +++++ >> scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh | 31 ++++++++++ >> 8 files changed, 216 insertions(+) >> create mode 100755 rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh >> create mode 100755 rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh >> create mode 100644 rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh >> create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in >> create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in >> create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make >> create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make >> >> diff --git a/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh >> new file mode 100755 >> index 000000000..6bbe830f2 >> --- /dev/null >> +++ b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh >> @@ -0,0 +1,42 @@ >> +#!/bin/bash >> + >> +set -e >> + >> +set_fit_keys() { >> + local r="image-kernel-fit" >> + cs_define_role "${r}" >> + >> + # HSM use case >> + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=kernel-fit" >> +} >> + >> +set_rauc_keys() { >> + local r="update" >> + cs_define_role "${r}" >> + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=rauc" >> + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" >> +} >> + >> +set_imx_habv4_keys() { >> + # HSM use case, assuming it contains only 1st CSF/IMG key >> + for i in 1 2 3 4; do >> + r="imx-habv4-srk${i}" >> + cs_define_role "${r}" >> + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=srk${i}" >> + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" >> + done >> + >> + r="imx-habv4-csf1" >> + cs_define_role ${r} >> + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=csf1" >> + >> + r="imx-habv4-img1" >> + cs_define_role ${r} >> + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=img1" >> +} >> + >> + >> +# HSM use case >> +set_fit_keys >> +set_rauc_keys >> +set_imx_habv4_keys >> diff --git a/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh >> new file mode 100755 >> index 000000000..0836d61d1 >> --- /dev/null >> +++ b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh >> @@ -0,0 +1,58 @@ >> +#!/bin/bash >> + >> +set -e >> + >> +import_fit_keys() { >> + local fit_cert_dir=fit >> + local r="image-kernel-fit" >> + cs_define_role "${r}" >> + >> + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${fit_cert_dir}/fit-4096-development.crt" >> + cs_import_pubkey_from_pem "${r}" "${fit_cert_dir}/fit-4096-development.key" >> + cs_import_privkey_from_pem "${r}" "${fit_cert_dir}/fit-4096-development.key" >> +} >> + >> +import_rauc_keys() { >> + local rauc_cert_dir=rauc >> + local r="update" >> + cs_define_role "${r}" >> + >> + # SoftHSM use case >> + cs_import_cert_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.cert.pem" >> + cs_import_pubkey_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.key.pem" >> + cs_import_privkey_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.key.pem" >> + >> + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" >> +} >> + >> +import_imx_habv4_keys() { >> + local imx_habv4_key_dir="habv4" >> + local crts="${imx_habv4_key_dir}/crts" >> + local keys="${imx_habv4_key_dir}/keys" >> + local OPENSSL_KEYPASS="${imx_habv4_key_dir}/keys/key_pass.txt" >> + >> + for i in 1 2 3 4; do >> + r="imx-habv4-srk${i}" >> + cs_define_role "${r}" >> + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${crts}/SRK${i}_sha256_4096_65537_v3_ca_crt.der" >> + cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${keys}/SRK${i}_sha256_4096_65537_v3_ca_key.pem" >> + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" >> + >> + r="imx-habv4-csf${i}" >> + cs_define_role "${r}" >> + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${crts}/CSF${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_crt.der" >> + cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${keys}/CSF${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_key.pem" >> + >> + r="imx-habv4-img${i}" >> + cs_define_role "${r}" >> + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${crts}/IMG${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_crt.der" >> + cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${keys}/IMG${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_key.pem" >> + done >> +} >> + >> + >> +# SoftHSM use case >> +cs_init_softhsm >> +import_fit_keys >> +import_rauc_keys >> +import_imx_habv4_keys >> diff --git a/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh >> new file mode 100644 >> index 000000000..83d6d54e3 >> --- /dev/null >> +++ b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh >> @@ -0,0 +1,10 @@ >> +#!/bin/bash >> + >> +if [ "$TYPE" = "SoftHSM" ]; then >> + mv ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh ptxdist-set-keys.sh >> + rm ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh >> + >> +elif [ "$TYPE" = "HSM with OpenSC support" ] || [ "$TYPE" = "other HSM" ]; then >> + mv ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh ptxdist-set-keys.sh >> + rm ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh >> +fi >> diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in >> new file mode 100644 >> index 000000000..e2108f870 >> --- /dev/null >> +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in >> @@ -0,0 +1,5 @@ >> +## SECTION=code_signing_provider >> + >> +config CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ >> + bool >> + prompt "@package@" >> diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in >> new file mode 100644 >> index 000000000..b84ba839c >> --- /dev/null >> +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in >> @@ -0,0 +1,14 @@ >> +## SECTION=code_signing >> + >> +config CODE_SIGNING >> + select HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING if CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ >> + >> +config CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER >> + default "@package@" if CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ >> + >> +config HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING >> + bool >> + select HOST_LIBP11 >> + select HOST_OPENSSL >> + select HOST_EXTRACT_CERT >> + @EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES@ >> diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make >> new file mode 100644 >> index 000000000..94830d92e >> --- /dev/null >> +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make >> @@ -0,0 +1,41 @@ >> +# -*-makefile-*- >> +# >> +# Copyright (C) @YEAR@ by @AUTHOR@ >> +# >> +# For further information about the PTXdist project and license conditions >> +# see the README file. >> +# >> + >> +# >> +# We provide this package >> +# >> +HOST_PACKAGES-$(PTXCONF_HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING) += host-@package@-code-signing >> + >> +# >> +# Paths and names >> +# >> +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_VERSION := @VERSION@ >> +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING := @package@-code-signing-$(HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_VERSION) >> +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_URL := file://local_src/@package@-code-signing >> +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_DIR := $(HOST_BUILDDIR)/$(HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING) >> + >> +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_CONF_TOOL := NO >> + >> +# ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- >> +# Compile >> +# ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- >> + >> +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_MAKE_ENV := \ >> + $(CODE_SIGNING_ENV) >> + >> +$(STATEDIR)/host-@package@-code-signing.compile: >> + @$(call targetinfo) >> + @$(call world/execute, HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING, \ >> + ./ptxdist-set-keys.sh) >> + @$(call touch) >> + >> +$(STATEDIR)/host-@package@-code-signing.install: >> + @$(call targetinfo) >> + @$(call touch) >> + >> +# vim: syntax=make >> diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make >> new file mode 100644 >> index 000000000..28cac750c >> --- /dev/null >> +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make >> @@ -0,0 +1,15 @@ >> +# -*-makefile-*- >> +# >> +# Copyright (C) @YEAR@ by @AUTHOR@ >> +# >> +# For further information about the PTXdist project and license conditions >> +# see the README file. >> +# >> + >> +ifndef PTXCONF_CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ >> +CODE_SIGNING_ENV += \ >> + PKCS11_MODULE_PATH=@MODULE_PATH@ >> + $(HSM_CODE_SIGNING_ENV) > > This line has no effect. I removed it. In the OpenSC case, no extra env is > needed and for other HSMs the file must be edited anyways and all need > extra environment can be added. You are right, this is a leftover from a previous construct where PKCS11_MODULE_PATH was added to HSM_CODE_SIGNING_ENV. HSM_CODE_SIGNING_ENV was then added to CODE_SIGNING_ENV. I decided to remove that extra variable but forgot to remove HSM_CODE_SIGNING_ENV here. Thanks, Bastian >> +endif >> + >> +# vim: syntax=make >> diff --git a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh >> index 6b405763b..805d8d9d3 100644 >> --- a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh >> +++ b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh >> @@ -486,3 +486,34 @@ ptxd_template_new_blspec_entry() { >> export -f ptxd_template_new_blspec_entry >> ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="blspec-entry" >> ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="create package for a bootloader spec entry" >> + >> +ptxd_template_new_code_signing_provider() { >> + export class="host-" >> + ptxd_template_read_basic && >> + ptxd_template_read_author && >> + ptxd_template_read_options "provider type" TYPE "SoftHSM" "HSM with OpenSC support" "other HSM" >> + package_filename="${package_filename}-code-signing" >> + local template_file="$(ptxd_template_file "${template}-choice-in")" >> + local filename="${PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR}/platforms/${class}${package_filename}-choice.in" >> + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" >> + template_file="$(ptxd_template_file "${template}-pre-make")" >> + filename="${PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR}/rules/pre/020-${package_filename}-hsm.make" >> + if [ "$TYPE" = "SoftHSM" ]; then >> + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select HOST_SOFTHSM" >> + elif [ "$TYPE" = "HSM with OpenSC support" ]; then >> + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select HOST_OPENSC >> + select HOST_OPENSC_PCSC" >> + export MODULE_PATH="\${PTXDIST_SYSROOT_HOST}/lib/pkcs11/opensc-pkcs11.so" >> + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" >> + elif [ "$TYPE" = "other HSM" ]; then >> + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select FIXME" >> + export MODULE_PATH="\${PTXDIST_SYSROOT_HOST}/fix/me" >> + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" >> + fi >> + ptxd_template_write_platform_rules >> + package="${package}-code-signing" >> + ptxd_template_write_src >> +} >> +export -f ptxd_template_new_code_signing_provider >> +ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="code-signing-provider" >> +ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="create package for a code signing provider" >> -- >> 2.27.0 >> >> >> _______________________________________________ >> ptxdist mailing list >> ptxdist@pengutronix.de >> To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de >> > -- Pengutronix e.K. | | Steuerwalder Str. 21 | http://www.pengutronix.de/ | 31137 Hildesheim, Germany | Phone: +49-5121-206917-0 | Amtsgericht Hildesheim, HRA 2686 | Fax: +49-5121-206917-5555 | _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* Re: [ptxdist] [APPLIED] package templates: add code-signing-provider template 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 2/6] package templates: add code-signing-provider template Bastian Krause 2020-06-18 11:40 ` Roland Hieber 2020-06-19 6:28 ` Michael Olbrich @ 2020-06-19 22:04 ` Michael Olbrich 2020-09-24 10:04 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 2/6] " Ladislav Michl 3 siblings, 0 replies; 24+ messages in thread From: Michael Olbrich @ 2020-06-19 22:04 UTC (permalink / raw) To: ptxdist; +Cc: Bastian Krause Thanks, applied as b1afc61b444742d0baf30cefb6324245ff9d3f1e. Michael [sent from post-receive hook] On Sat, 20 Jun 2020 00:04:06 +0200, Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> wrote: > A ptxdist code signing provider is a package which selects the required > host tools needed for the code signing helpers to work. A shell script > is needed to define roles, set PKCS#11 URIs and import keys if SoftHSM > is used. In order to simplify its creation provide a template along with > an example script. > > Signed-off-by: Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> > Message-Id: <20200617143125.23999-3-bst@pengutronix.de> > Tested-by: Roland Hieber <rhi@pengutronix.de> > Reviewed-by: Roland Hieber <rhi@pengutronix.de> > Signed-off-by: Michael Olbrich <m.olbrich@pengutronix.de> > > diff --git a/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh > new file mode 100755 > index 000000000000..6bbe830f2a2d > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh > @@ -0,0 +1,42 @@ > +#!/bin/bash > + > +set -e > + > +set_fit_keys() { > + local r="image-kernel-fit" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + > + # HSM use case > + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=kernel-fit" > +} > + > +set_rauc_keys() { > + local r="update" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=rauc" > + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" > +} > + > +set_imx_habv4_keys() { > + # HSM use case, assuming it contains only 1st CSF/IMG key > + for i in 1 2 3 4; do > + r="imx-habv4-srk${i}" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=srk${i}" > + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" > + done > + > + r="imx-habv4-csf1" > + cs_define_role ${r} > + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=csf1" > + > + r="imx-habv4-img1" > + cs_define_role ${r} > + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=img1" > +} > + > + > +# HSM use case > +set_fit_keys > +set_rauc_keys > +set_imx_habv4_keys > diff --git a/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh > new file mode 100755 > index 000000000000..0836d61d13b7 > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh > @@ -0,0 +1,58 @@ > +#!/bin/bash > + > +set -e > + > +import_fit_keys() { > + local fit_cert_dir=fit > + local r="image-kernel-fit" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + > + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${fit_cert_dir}/fit-4096-development.crt" > + cs_import_pubkey_from_pem "${r}" "${fit_cert_dir}/fit-4096-development.key" > + cs_import_privkey_from_pem "${r}" "${fit_cert_dir}/fit-4096-development.key" > +} > + > +import_rauc_keys() { > + local rauc_cert_dir=rauc > + local r="update" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + > + # SoftHSM use case > + cs_import_cert_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.cert.pem" > + cs_import_pubkey_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.key.pem" > + cs_import_privkey_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.key.pem" > + > + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" > +} > + > +import_imx_habv4_keys() { > + local imx_habv4_key_dir="habv4" > + local crts="${imx_habv4_key_dir}/crts" > + local keys="${imx_habv4_key_dir}/keys" > + local OPENSSL_KEYPASS="${imx_habv4_key_dir}/keys/key_pass.txt" > + > + for i in 1 2 3 4; do > + r="imx-habv4-srk${i}" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${crts}/SRK${i}_sha256_4096_65537_v3_ca_crt.der" > + cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${keys}/SRK${i}_sha256_4096_65537_v3_ca_key.pem" > + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" > + > + r="imx-habv4-csf${i}" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${crts}/CSF${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_crt.der" > + cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${keys}/CSF${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_key.pem" > + > + r="imx-habv4-img${i}" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${crts}/IMG${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_crt.der" > + cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${keys}/IMG${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_key.pem" > + done > +} > + > + > +# SoftHSM use case > +cs_init_softhsm > +import_fit_keys > +import_rauc_keys > +import_imx_habv4_keys > diff --git a/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000000..83d6d54e3541 > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh > @@ -0,0 +1,10 @@ > +#!/bin/bash > + > +if [ "$TYPE" = "SoftHSM" ]; then > + mv ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh ptxdist-set-keys.sh > + rm ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh > + > +elif [ "$TYPE" = "HSM with OpenSC support" ] || [ "$TYPE" = "other HSM" ]; then > + mv ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh ptxdist-set-keys.sh > + rm ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh > +fi > diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000000..e2108f870cbf > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in > @@ -0,0 +1,5 @@ > +## SECTION=code_signing_provider > + > +config CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ > + bool > + prompt "@package@" > diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000000..b84ba839c124 > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in > @@ -0,0 +1,14 @@ > +## SECTION=code_signing > + > +config CODE_SIGNING > + select HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING if CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ > + > +config CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER > + default "@package@" if CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ > + > +config HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING > + bool > + select HOST_LIBP11 > + select HOST_OPENSSL > + select HOST_EXTRACT_CERT > + @EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES@ > diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000000..94830d92e9e7 > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make > @@ -0,0 +1,41 @@ > +# -*-makefile-*- > +# > +# Copyright (C) @YEAR@ by @AUTHOR@ > +# > +# For further information about the PTXdist project and license conditions > +# see the README file. > +# > + > +# > +# We provide this package > +# > +HOST_PACKAGES-$(PTXCONF_HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING) += host-@package@-code-signing > + > +# > +# Paths and names > +# > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_VERSION := @VERSION@ > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING := @package@-code-signing-$(HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_VERSION) > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_URL := file://local_src/@package@-code-signing > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_DIR := $(HOST_BUILDDIR)/$(HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING) > + > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_CONF_TOOL := NO > + > +# ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- > +# Compile > +# ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- > + > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_MAKE_ENV := \ > + $(CODE_SIGNING_ENV) > + > +$(STATEDIR)/host-@package@-code-signing.compile: > + @$(call targetinfo) > + @$(call world/execute, HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING, \ > + ./ptxdist-set-keys.sh) > + @$(call touch) > + > +$(STATEDIR)/host-@package@-code-signing.install: > + @$(call targetinfo) > + @$(call touch) > + > +# vim: syntax=make > diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000000..8f24f650df42 > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make > @@ -0,0 +1,14 @@ > +# -*-makefile-*- > +# > +# Copyright (C) @YEAR@ by @AUTHOR@ > +# > +# For further information about the PTXdist project and license conditions > +# see the README file. > +# > + > +ifndef PTXCONF_CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ > +CODE_SIGNING_ENV += \ > + PKCS11_MODULE_PATH=@MODULE_PATH@ > +endif > + > +# vim: syntax=make > diff --git a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh > index 9cace6c14a0b..fc55126fac38 100644 > --- a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh > +++ b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh > @@ -489,3 +489,34 @@ ptxd_template_new_blspec_entry() { > export -f ptxd_template_new_blspec_entry > ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="blspec-entry" > ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="create package for a bootloader spec entry" > + > +ptxd_template_new_code_signing_provider() { > + export class="host-" > + ptxd_template_read_basic && > + ptxd_template_read_author && > + ptxd_template_read_options "provider type" TYPE "SoftHSM" "HSM with OpenSC support" "other HSM" > + package_filename="${package_filename}-code-signing" > + local template_file="$(ptxd_template_file "${template}-choice-in")" > + local filename="${PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR}/platforms/${class}${package_filename}-choice.in" > + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" > + template_file="$(ptxd_template_file "${template}-pre-make")" > + filename="${PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR}/rules/pre/020-${package_filename}-hsm.make" > + if [ "$TYPE" = "SoftHSM" ]; then > + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select HOST_SOFTHSM" > + elif [ "$TYPE" = "HSM with OpenSC support" ]; then > + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select HOST_OPENSC > + select HOST_OPENSC_PCSC" > + export MODULE_PATH="\${PTXDIST_SYSROOT_HOST}/lib/pkcs11/opensc-pkcs11.so" > + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" > + elif [ "$TYPE" = "other HSM" ]; then > + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select FIXME" > + export MODULE_PATH="\${PTXDIST_SYSROOT_HOST}/fix/me" > + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" > + fi > + ptxd_template_write_platform_rules > + package="${package}-code-signing" > + ptxd_template_write_src > +} > +export -f ptxd_template_new_code_signing_provider > +ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="code-signing-provider" > +ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="create package for a code signing provider" _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* Re: [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 2/6] package templates: add code-signing-provider template 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 2/6] package templates: add code-signing-provider template Bastian Krause ` (2 preceding siblings ...) 2020-06-19 22:04 ` [ptxdist] [APPLIED] " Michael Olbrich @ 2020-09-24 10:04 ` Ladislav Michl 2020-09-24 11:05 ` Bastian Krause 3 siblings, 1 reply; 24+ messages in thread From: Ladislav Michl @ 2020-09-24 10:04 UTC (permalink / raw) To: ptxdist; +Cc: Bastian Krause Hi and sorry to revive this old patch. I just hadn't time to finish conversion to code-signing-provider sooner... On Wed, Jun 17, 2020 at 04:31:21PM +0200, Bastian Krause wrote: > A ptxdist code signing provider is a package which selects the required > host tools needed for the code signing helpers to work. A shell script > is needed to define roles, set PKCS#11 URIs and import keys if SoftHSM > is used. In order to simplify its creation provide a template along with > an example script. > > Signed-off-by: Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> > --- > Changes since v2: > - rename srk object name for consistency reasons > - ask user about HSM type > - split HSM/SoftHSM ptxdist-set-keys.sh cases into separate files > - introduce wizard.sh to generate ptxdist-set-keys.sh HSM case specific > - set dependencies HSM case specific > - introduce pre rule template to extend CODE_SIGNING_ENV HSM case > specific > --- > .../ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh | 42 ++++++++++++++ > .../ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh | 58 +++++++++++++++++++ > .../templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh | 10 ++++ > .../template-code-signing-provider-choice-in | 5 ++ > .../template-code-signing-provider-in | 14 +++++ > .../template-code-signing-provider-make | 41 +++++++++++++ > .../template-code-signing-provider-pre-make | 15 +++++ > scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh | 31 ++++++++++ > 8 files changed, 216 insertions(+) > create mode 100755 rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh > create mode 100755 rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh > create mode 100644 rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh > create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in > create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in > create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make > create mode 100644 rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make > > diff --git a/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh > new file mode 100755 > index 000000000..6bbe830f2 > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh > @@ -0,0 +1,42 @@ > +#!/bin/bash > + > +set -e > + > +set_fit_keys() { > + local r="image-kernel-fit" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + > + # HSM use case > + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=kernel-fit" > +} > + > +set_rauc_keys() { > + local r="update" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=rauc" > + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" > +} > + > +set_imx_habv4_keys() { > + # HSM use case, assuming it contains only 1st CSF/IMG key > + for i in 1 2 3 4; do > + r="imx-habv4-srk${i}" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=srk${i}" > + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" > + done > + > + r="imx-habv4-csf1" > + cs_define_role ${r} > + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=csf1" > + > + r="imx-habv4-img1" > + cs_define_role ${r} > + cs_set_uri "${r}" "pkcs11:token=foo;object=img1" > +} > + > + > +# HSM use case > +set_fit_keys > +set_rauc_keys > +set_imx_habv4_keys > diff --git a/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh > new file mode 100755 > index 000000000..0836d61d1 > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh > @@ -0,0 +1,58 @@ > +#!/bin/bash > + > +set -e > + > +import_fit_keys() { > + local fit_cert_dir=fit > + local r="image-kernel-fit" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + > + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${fit_cert_dir}/fit-4096-development.crt" > + cs_import_pubkey_from_pem "${r}" "${fit_cert_dir}/fit-4096-development.key" > + cs_import_privkey_from_pem "${r}" "${fit_cert_dir}/fit-4096-development.key" > +} > + > +import_rauc_keys() { > + local rauc_cert_dir=rauc > + local r="update" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + > + # SoftHSM use case > + cs_import_cert_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.cert.pem" > + cs_import_pubkey_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.key.pem" > + cs_import_privkey_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.key.pem" > + > + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" > +} For those previously using scripts/rauc-gen-test-certs.sh above shoud read: import_rauc_keys() { local rauc_cert_dir=${PTXDIST_WORKSPACE}/configs/rauc local r="update" cs_define_role "${r}" # SoftHSM use case cs_import_cert_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.cert.pem" cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.key.pem" cs_append_ca_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/ca.cert.pem" } scripts/rauc-gen-test-certs.sh generated those files and back then there was following note: =============================================================================== Note that the default application should be to set up a public key infrastructure at your site and use keys and certificates genereated by these. In oder to use the just generated files in your BSP for testing purpose or if you do not intend to use real authentification, follow the instructions below. Place the key and certificate file in your platform-dir's config/ folder: cp rauc-openssl-ca/private/rauc.key.pem <platform-dir>/config/rauc/rauc.key.pem cp rauc-openssl-ca/rauc.cert.pem <platform-dir>/config/rauc/rauc.cert.pem Place the keyring file in your platform-dir's projectroot/ folder: cp rauc-openssl-ca/ca.cert.pem <plaform-dir>/projectroot/etc/rauc/ca.cert.pem =============================================================================== Perhaps it would be nice to mention than in documentation as it could save time to others. Thanks to Enrico Jorns for help with debugging that. > +import_imx_habv4_keys() { > + local imx_habv4_key_dir="habv4" > + local crts="${imx_habv4_key_dir}/crts" > + local keys="${imx_habv4_key_dir}/keys" > + local OPENSSL_KEYPASS="${imx_habv4_key_dir}/keys/key_pass.txt" > + > + for i in 1 2 3 4; do > + r="imx-habv4-srk${i}" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${crts}/SRK${i}_sha256_4096_65537_v3_ca_crt.der" > + cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${keys}/SRK${i}_sha256_4096_65537_v3_ca_key.pem" > + cs_append_ca_from_uri "${r}" > + > + r="imx-habv4-csf${i}" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${crts}/CSF${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_crt.der" > + cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${keys}/CSF${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_key.pem" > + > + r="imx-habv4-img${i}" > + cs_define_role "${r}" > + cs_import_cert_from_der "${r}" "${crts}/IMG${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_crt.der" > + cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" "${keys}/IMG${i}_1_sha256_4096_65537_v3_usr_key.pem" > + done > +} > + > + > +# SoftHSM use case > +cs_init_softhsm > +import_fit_keys > +import_rauc_keys > +import_imx_habv4_keys > diff --git a/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000..83d6d54e3 > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/code-signing-provider/wizard.sh > @@ -0,0 +1,10 @@ > +#!/bin/bash > + > +if [ "$TYPE" = "SoftHSM" ]; then > + mv ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh ptxdist-set-keys.sh > + rm ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh > + > +elif [ "$TYPE" = "HSM with OpenSC support" ] || [ "$TYPE" = "other HSM" ]; then > + mv ptxdist-set-keys-hsm.sh ptxdist-set-keys.sh > + rm ptxdist-set-keys-softhsm.sh > +fi > diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000..e2108f870 > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-choice-in > @@ -0,0 +1,5 @@ > +## SECTION=code_signing_provider > + > +config CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ > + bool > + prompt "@package@" > diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000..b84ba839c > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-in > @@ -0,0 +1,14 @@ > +## SECTION=code_signing > + > +config CODE_SIGNING > + select HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING if CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ > + > +config CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER > + default "@package@" if CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ > + > +config HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING > + bool > + select HOST_LIBP11 > + select HOST_OPENSSL > + select HOST_EXTRACT_CERT > + @EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES@ > diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000..94830d92e > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-make > @@ -0,0 +1,41 @@ > +# -*-makefile-*- > +# > +# Copyright (C) @YEAR@ by @AUTHOR@ > +# > +# For further information about the PTXdist project and license conditions > +# see the README file. > +# > + > +# > +# We provide this package > +# > +HOST_PACKAGES-$(PTXCONF_HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING) += host-@package@-code-signing > + > +# > +# Paths and names > +# > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_VERSION := @VERSION@ > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING := @package@-code-signing-$(HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_VERSION) > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_URL := file://local_src/@package@-code-signing > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_DIR := $(HOST_BUILDDIR)/$(HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING) > + > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_CONF_TOOL := NO > + > +# ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- > +# Compile > +# ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- > + > +HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING_MAKE_ENV := \ > + $(CODE_SIGNING_ENV) > + > +$(STATEDIR)/host-@package@-code-signing.compile: > + @$(call targetinfo) > + @$(call world/execute, HOST_@PACKAGE@_CODE_SIGNING, \ > + ./ptxdist-set-keys.sh) > + @$(call touch) > + > +$(STATEDIR)/host-@package@-code-signing.install: > + @$(call targetinfo) > + @$(call touch) > + > +# vim: syntax=make > diff --git a/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000..28cac750c > --- /dev/null > +++ b/rules/templates/template-code-signing-provider-pre-make > @@ -0,0 +1,15 @@ > +# -*-makefile-*- > +# > +# Copyright (C) @YEAR@ by @AUTHOR@ > +# > +# For further information about the PTXdist project and license conditions > +# see the README file. > +# > + > +ifndef PTXCONF_CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_@PACKAGE@ > +CODE_SIGNING_ENV += \ > + PKCS11_MODULE_PATH=@MODULE_PATH@ > + $(HSM_CODE_SIGNING_ENV) > +endif > + > +# vim: syntax=make > diff --git a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh > index 6b405763b..805d8d9d3 100644 > --- a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh > +++ b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh > @@ -486,3 +486,34 @@ ptxd_template_new_blspec_entry() { > export -f ptxd_template_new_blspec_entry > ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="blspec-entry" > ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="create package for a bootloader spec entry" > + > +ptxd_template_new_code_signing_provider() { > + export class="host-" > + ptxd_template_read_basic && > + ptxd_template_read_author && > + ptxd_template_read_options "provider type" TYPE "SoftHSM" "HSM with OpenSC support" "other HSM" > + package_filename="${package_filename}-code-signing" > + local template_file="$(ptxd_template_file "${template}-choice-in")" > + local filename="${PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR}/platforms/${class}${package_filename}-choice.in" > + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" > + template_file="$(ptxd_template_file "${template}-pre-make")" > + filename="${PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR}/rules/pre/020-${package_filename}-hsm.make" > + if [ "$TYPE" = "SoftHSM" ]; then > + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select HOST_SOFTHSM" > + elif [ "$TYPE" = "HSM with OpenSC support" ]; then > + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select HOST_OPENSC > + select HOST_OPENSC_PCSC" > + export MODULE_PATH="\${PTXDIST_SYSROOT_HOST}/lib/pkcs11/opensc-pkcs11.so" > + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" > + elif [ "$TYPE" = "other HSM" ]; then > + export EXTRA_DEPENDENCIES="select FIXME" > + export MODULE_PATH="\${PTXDIST_SYSROOT_HOST}/fix/me" > + ptxd_template_filter "${template_file}" "${filename}" > + fi > + ptxd_template_write_platform_rules > + package="${package}-code-signing" > + ptxd_template_write_src > +} > +export -f ptxd_template_new_code_signing_provider > +ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="code-signing-provider" > +ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="create package for a code signing provider" > -- > 2.27.0 > > > _______________________________________________ > ptxdist mailing list > ptxdist@pengutronix.de > To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* Re: [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 2/6] package templates: add code-signing-provider template 2020-09-24 10:04 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 2/6] " Ladislav Michl @ 2020-09-24 11:05 ` Bastian Krause 2020-09-24 11:15 ` Ladislav Michl 0 siblings, 1 reply; 24+ messages in thread From: Bastian Krause @ 2020-09-24 11:05 UTC (permalink / raw) To: ptxdist, Ladislav Michl Hi ladis, On 9/24/20 12:04 PM, Ladislav Michl wrote: > Hi and sorry to revive this old patch. I just hadn't time to finish > conversion to code-signing-provider sooner... I'm always happy if we can improvde documentation patches, even after some time has passed :) > For those previously using scripts/rauc-gen-test-certs.sh above shoud > read: import_rauc_keys() { local > rauc_cert_dir=${PTXDIST_WORKSPACE}/configs/rauc This is not intended. Let me quote the relevant documentation snippets: "Finally, one or several code signing providers supply the mapping from roles to the respective key material or even provide it themselves for development." [1] "A code signing provider is a package responsible for providing the role ↔ PKCS#11 URI relationships in case an HSM is used, or for providing the key material in case SoftHSM is used." [2] "In case of SoftHSM use cases the keys should also be placed inside local_src/<name>-code-signing/" [3] The key material should reside *in* the code signing provider, just as in the devel provider [4]. [1] https://www.ptxdist.org/doc/dev_code_signing.html#code-signing [2] https://www.ptxdist.org/doc/dev_code_signing.html#code-signing-providers [3] https://www.ptxdist.org/doc/dev_code_signing.html#creating-custom-code-signing-providers [4] https://git.pengutronix.de/cgit/ptx-code-signing-dev/ > local r="update" cs_define_role "${r}" > > # SoftHSM use case cs_import_cert_from_pem "${r}" > "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.cert.pem" cs_import_key_from_pem "${r}" > "${rauc_cert_dir}/rauc.key.pem" cs_append_ca_from_pem "${r}" > "${rauc_cert_dir}/ca.cert.pem" } > > scripts/rauc-gen-test-certs.sh generated those files and back then > there was following note: > =============================================================================== > > Note that the default application should be to set up a public key > infrastructure at your site and use keys and certificates genereated > by these. > > In oder to use the just generated files in your BSP for testing > purpose or if you do not intend to use real authentification, follow > the instructions below. > > Place the key and certificate file in your platform-dir's config/ > folder: > > cp rauc-openssl-ca/private/rauc.key.pem > <platform-dir>/config/rauc/rauc.key.pem ptxdist should have bailed out if it found a file at that location. Unfortunately we checked for "<platform-dir>/config/rauc/rauc.key" (missing the .pem suffix). That's a bug, fixed with 20200924104811.30246-1-bst@pengutronix.de on the ptxdist mailing list. > cp rauc-openssl-ca/rauc.cert.pem > <platform-dir>/config/rauc/rauc.cert.pem > > Place the keyring file in your platform-dir's projectroot/ folder: > > cp rauc-openssl-ca/ca.cert.pem > <plaform-dir>/projectroot/etc/rauc/ca.cert.pem > > =============================================================================== > > Perhaps it would be nice to mention than in documentation as it > could save time to others. After reading the quoted documentation snippets above (and assuming the error message triggers correctly now), do you still think this needs documentation improvement? If yes, you're very welcome to add an explanation to the signing doc section (maybe an info box?) to help others migrate their development key material into a code signing provider for the sake of backwards compatibility. Regards, Bastian -- Pengutronix e.K. | | Steuerwalder Str. 21 | http://www.pengutronix.de/ | 31137 Hildesheim, Germany | Phone: +49-5121-206917-0 | Amtsgericht Hildesheim, HRA 2686 | Fax: +49-5121-206917-5555 | _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* Re: [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 2/6] package templates: add code-signing-provider template 2020-09-24 11:05 ` Bastian Krause @ 2020-09-24 11:15 ` Ladislav Michl 2020-09-24 12:23 ` Bastian Krause 0 siblings, 1 reply; 24+ messages in thread From: Ladislav Michl @ 2020-09-24 11:15 UTC (permalink / raw) To: Bastian Krause; +Cc: ptxdist Hi Bastian, On Thu, Sep 24, 2020 at 01:05:31PM +0200, Bastian Krause wrote: [doc quote deleted] > After reading the quoted documentation snippets above (and assuming the > error message triggers correctly now), do you still think this needs > documentation improvement? If yes, you're very welcome to add an > explanation to the signing doc section (maybe an info box?) to help > others migrate their development key material into a code signing > provider for the sake of backwards compatibility. I needed to handle this situation (I guess many people find it familiar): Board is using rauc for updates, keys was generated using previously provided script and boards were supposed to stay near developers until software stack is finalized. As always that was not the case and now we need to update then. Templated provider does not add ca.cert.pem, so generating rauc will end with error (Failed to create bundle: failed signing bundle: signature verification failed: Verify error: unable to get local issuer certificate). This way you can at least prepare firmware using recent ptxdist with properly generated keys. If there is any other option, please let me know. ladis _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* Re: [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 2/6] package templates: add code-signing-provider template 2020-09-24 11:15 ` Ladislav Michl @ 2020-09-24 12:23 ` Bastian Krause 0 siblings, 0 replies; 24+ messages in thread From: Bastian Krause @ 2020-09-24 12:23 UTC (permalink / raw) To: ptxdist, Ladislav Michl On 9/24/20 1:15 PM, Ladislav Michl wrote: > On Thu, Sep 24, 2020 at 01:05:31PM +0200, Bastian Krause wrote: > [doc quote deleted] >> After reading the quoted documentation snippets above (and assuming the >> error message triggers correctly now), do you still think this needs >> documentation improvement? If yes, you're very welcome to add an >> explanation to the signing doc section (maybe an info box?) to help >> others migrate their development key material into a code signing >> provider for the sake of backwards compatibility. > > I needed to handle this situation (I guess many people find it familiar): > Board is using rauc for updates, keys was generated using previously > provided script and boards were supposed to stay near developers until > software stack is finalized. As always that was not the case and now > we need to update then. Templated provider does not add ca.cert.pem, > so generating rauc will end with error (Failed to create bundle: > failed signing bundle: signature verification failed: Verify error: > unable to get local issuer certificate). > > This way you can at least prepare firmware using recent ptxdist > with properly generated keys. If there is any other option, > please let me know. We had a short discussion on the #ptdist irc channel: ladis' point is to mention.. cs_append_ca_from_pem "${r}" "${rauc_cert_dir}/ca.cert.pem" ..which is required for people who migrate from the previous key generation script [1]. My point is to move the key material into local_src/<provider>/. We agreed that both points are valid. Regards, Bastian [1] 001a500ed ("scripts: add script that generates test certificates for RAUC") -- Pengutronix e.K. | | Steuerwalder Str. 21 | http://www.pengutronix.de/ | 31137 Hildesheim, Germany | Phone: +49-5121-206917-0 | Amtsgericht Hildesheim, HRA 2686 | Fax: +49-5121-206917-5555 | _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 3/6] doc: dev_manual: split up into multiple files 2020-06-17 14:31 [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 0/6] Add code-signing-provider template, add code signing docs Bastian Krause 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 1/6] ptxd_lib_template: add ptxd_template_read_options Bastian Krause 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 2/6] package templates: add code-signing-provider template Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-17 14:31 ` Bastian Krause 2020-06-19 22:04 ` [ptxdist] [APPLIED] " Michael Olbrich 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 4/6] doc: move code signing docs from scripts/ into doc/ Bastian Krause ` (2 subsequent siblings) 5 siblings, 1 reply; 24+ messages in thread From: Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-17 14:31 UTC (permalink / raw) To: ptxdist; +Cc: Bastian Krause, Roland Hieber Split the lengthy developer's manual into multiple files to ease navigation when editing. No further change to the content. Signed-off-by: Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> Reviewed-by: Roland Hieber <rhi@pengutronix.de> Tested-by: Ladislav Michl <ladis@linux-mips.org> --- No changes since (implicit) v1. --- doc/dev_add_bin_only_files.rst | 105 ++ doc/dev_add_new_pkgs.rst | 1339 +++++++++++++++++++ doc/dev_create_new_pkg_templates.rst | 77 ++ doc/dev_dir_hierarchy.rst | 108 ++ doc/dev_layers_in_ptxdist.rst | 111 ++ doc/dev_manual.rst | 1764 +------------------------- 6 files changed, 1749 insertions(+), 1755 deletions(-) create mode 100644 doc/dev_add_bin_only_files.rst create mode 100644 doc/dev_add_new_pkgs.rst create mode 100644 doc/dev_create_new_pkg_templates.rst create mode 100644 doc/dev_dir_hierarchy.rst create mode 100644 doc/dev_layers_in_ptxdist.rst diff --git a/doc/dev_add_bin_only_files.rst b/doc/dev_add_bin_only_files.rst new file mode 100644 index 000000000..9031e437c --- /dev/null +++ b/doc/dev_add_bin_only_files.rst @@ -0,0 +1,105 @@ +.. _adding_files: + +Adding Binary Only Files +------------------------ + +Sometimes a few binary files have to be added into the root filesystem. +Or - to be more precise - some files, that do not need to be built in +any way. + +On the other hand, sometimes files should be included that are not +covered by any open source license and so, should not be shipped in the +source code format. + +Add Binary Files File by File +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ + +Doing to on a file by file base can happen by just using the ``install_copy`` +macro in the *targetinstall* stage in our own customized rules file. + +.. code-block:: none + + @$(call install_copy, binary_example, 0, 0, 0644, \ + </path/to/some/file/>ptx_logo.png, \ + /example/ptx_logo.png) + +It copies the file ``ptx_logo.png`` from some location to target’s root +filesystem. Refer :ref:`install_copy` for further information about using the +``install_copy`` macro. + +The disadvantage of this method is: if we want to install more than one +file, we need one call to the ``install_copy`` macro per file. This is +even harder if not only a set of files is to be installed, but a whole +directory tree with files instead. + +Add Binary Files via an Archive +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ + +If a whole tree of files is to be installed, working with a *tar* based +archive could make life easier. In this case the archive itself provides +all the required information the files are needing to be installed in a +correct manner: + +- the file itself and its name + +- the directory structure and the final location of every file in this + structure + +- user and group ID on a per file base + +.. code-block:: none + + @$(call install_archive, binary_example, -, -, \ + </path/to/an/>archive.tgz, /) + +Refer :ref:`install_archive` for further information about using the +``install_archive`` macro. + +Using an archive can be useful to install parts of the root filesystem +that are not covered by any open source license. Its possible to ship +the binaries within the regular BSP, without the need for their sources. +However it is possible for the customer to re-create everything required +from the BSP to get their target up and running again. + +Another use case for the archive method could be the support for +different development teams. One team provides a software component in +the archive format, the other team does not need to build it but can use +it in the same way than every other software component. + +Creating a Rules File +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ + +Let PTXdist create one for us. + +.. code-block:: text + + $ ptxdist newpackage file + + ptxdist: creating a new 'file' package: + + ptxdist: enter package name.......: my_binfiles + ptxdist: enter version number.....: 1 + ptxdist: enter package author.....: My Name <me@my-org.com> + ptxdist: enter package section....: rootfs + +Now two new files are present in the BSP: + +#. ``rules/my_binfiles.in`` The template for the menu + +#. ``rules/my_binfiles.make`` The rules template + +Both files now must be customized to meet our requirements. Due to the +answer *rootfs* to the “``enter package section``” question, we will +find the new menu entry in: + +.. code-block:: text + + Root Filesystem ---> + < > my_binfiles (NEW) + +Enabling this new entry will also run our stages in +``rules/my_binfiles.make`` the next time we enter: + +.. code-block:: text + + $ ptxdist go diff --git a/doc/dev_add_new_pkgs.rst b/doc/dev_add_new_pkgs.rst new file mode 100644 index 000000000..4ae2765c2 --- /dev/null +++ b/doc/dev_add_new_pkgs.rst @@ -0,0 +1,1339 @@ +.. _adding_new_packages: + +Adding New Packages +------------------- + +PTXdist provides a huge amount of applications sufficient for the most +embedded use cases. But there is still need for some fancy new packages. +This section describes the steps and the background on how to integrate +new packages into the project. + +At first a summary about possible application types which PTXdist can +handle: + +- **host type**: This kind of package is built to run on the build + host. Most of the time such a package is needed if another + target-relevant package needs to generate some data. For example the + *glib* package depends on its own to create some data. But if it is + compiled for the target, it can’t do so. That’s why a host glib + package is required to provide these utilities runnable on the build + host. It sounds strange to build a host package, even if on the build + host such utilities are already installed. But this way ensures that + there are no dependencies regarding the build host system. + +- **target type**: This kind of package is built for the target. + +- **cross type**: This kind of package is built for the build host, but + creates architecture specific data for the target. + +- **src-autoconf-prog**: This kind of package is built for the target. + It is intended for development, as it does not handle a released + archive but a plain source project instead. Creating such a package + will also create a small autotools based source template project on + demand to give the developer an easy point to start. This template is + prepared to build a single executable program. For further details refer + section :ref:`adding_src_autoconf_exec`. + +- **src-autoconf-lib**: This kind of package is built for the target. + It is intended for development, as it does not handle a released + archive but a plain source project instead. Creating such a package + will also create a small autotools/libtool based source template + project on demand to give the developer an easy point to start. This + template is prepared to build a single shared library. For further + details refer section :ref:`adding_src_autoconf_lib`. + +- **src-autoconf-proglib**: This kind of package is built for the + target. It is intended for development, as it does not handle a + released archive but a plain source project instead. Creating such a + package will also create a small autotools/libtool based template + project on demand to give the developer an easy point to start. This + template is prepared to build a single shared library and a single + executable program. The program will be linked against the shared + library. For further details refer section :ref:`adding_src_autoconf_exec_lib`. + +- **file**: This kind of package is intended to add a few simple files + into the build process. We assume these files do not need any + processing, they are ready to use and must only be present in the + build process or at run-time (HTML files for example). Refer to the + section :ref:`adding_files` for further details on how to use + it. + +- **src-make-prog**: This kind of package is built for the target. It’s + intended for development, as it does not handle a released archive + but a plain source project instead. Creating such a package will also + create a simple makefile-based template project the developer can use + as a starting point for development. + +- **src-cmake-prog**: This kind of package is built for the target. + It’s intended for developments based on the *cmake* buildsystem. + Various projects are using *cmake* instead of *make* and can be built + with this package type. PTXdist will prepare it to compile sources in + accordance to the target libraries and their settings. Creating such + a package will also create a simple template project to be used as a + starting point for development. + +- **src-qmake-prog**: This kind of package is built for the target. + It’s intended for developments based on the *qmake* buildsystem. If + the developer is going to develop a QT based application, this rule + is prepared to compile sources in accordance to the target libraries + and their settings. Creating such a package will also create a simple + template project to be used as a starting point for development. + +- **src-meson-prog**: This kind of package is built for the target. + It’s intended for developments based on the *meson* buildsystem. + Various projects are using *meson* today and can be built + with this package type. PTXdist will prepare it to compile sources in + accordance to the target libraries and their settings. Creating such + a package will also create a simple template project to be used as a + starting point for development. + +- **font**: This package is a helper to add X font files to the root + filesystem. This package does not create an additional IPKG, instead + it adds the font to the existing font IPKG. This includes the + generation of the directory index files, required by the Xorg + framework to recognize the font file. + +- **src-linux-driver**: This kind of package builds an out of tree + kernel driver. It also creates a driver template to give the + developer an easy point to start. + +- **kernel**: PTXdist comes with the ability to handle one kernel in its + platform. This type of package enables us to handle more than one kernel in + the project. + +- **barebox**: PTXdist comes with the ability to handle one bootloader in its + platform. This type of package enables us to handle more than one bootloader + in the project. + +- **image-tgz**: This kind of package creates a tar ball from a list of + packages. It is often uses as an input for other image packages. + +- **image-genimage**: This kind of package can handle all kind of image + generation for almost every target independent of its complexity. + +- **blspec-entry**: PTXdist comes with the ability to handle one bootspec in its + platform. This type of package enables us to handle more than one bootspec + in the project. + +.. _foo_example: + +Rule File Creation +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ + +To create such a new package, we create a project local ``rules/`` +directory first. Then we run + +.. code-block:: text + + $ ptxdist newpackage <package type> + +If we omit the <``package type``\ >, PTXdist will list all available +package types. + +In our first example, we want to add a new target type archive package. +When running the + +.. code-block:: text + + $ ptxdist newpackage target + +command, PTXdist asks a few questions about this package. This +information is the basic data PTXdist must know about the package. + +.. code-block:: text + + ptxdist: creating a new 'target' package: + + ptxdist: enter package name.......: foo + ptxdist: enter version number.....: 1.1.0 + ptxdist: enter URL of basedir.....: http://www.foo.com/download/src + ptxdist: enter suffix.............: tar.gz + ptxdist: enter package author.....: My Name <me@my-org.com> + ptxdist: enter package section....: project_specific + +What we have to answer: + +- **package name**: As this kind of package handles a source archive, + the correct answer here is the basename of the archive’s file name. + If its full name is ``foo-1.1.0.tar.gz``, then ``foo`` is the + basename to enter here. + +- **version number**: Most source archives are using a release or + version number in their file name. If its full name is + ``foo-1.1.0.tar.gz``, then ``1.1.0`` is the version number to enter + here. + +- **URL of basedir**: This URL tells PTXdist where to download the + source archive from the web (if not already done). If the full URL to + download the archive is + ``http://www.foo.com/download/src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz``, the basedir + part ``http://www.foo.com/download/src`` is to be entered here. + +- **suffix**: Archives are using various formats for distribution. + PTXdist uses the *suffix* entry to select the matching extraction + tool. If the archive’s full name is ``foo-1.1.0.tar.gz``, then + ``tar.gz`` is the suffix to enter here. + +- **package author**: If we intend to contribute this new package to + PTXdist mainline, we should add our name here. This name will be used + in the copyright note of the rule file and will also be added to the + generated ipkg. When you run ``ptxdist setup`` prior to this call, + you can enter your name and your email address, so PTXdist will use + it as the default (very handy if you intend to add many new + packages). + +- **package section**: We can enter here the menu section name where + our new package menu entry should be listed. In the first step we can + leave the default name unchanged. It’s a string in the menu file + only, so changing it later on is still possible. + +Make it Work +~~~~~~~~~~~~ + +Generating the rule file is only one of the required steps to get a new +package. The next steps to make it work are to check if all stages are +working as expected and to select the required parts to get them +installed in the target root filesystem. Also we must find a reasonable +location where to add our new menu entry to configure the package. + +The generated skeleton starts to add the new menu entry in the main +configure menu (if we left the section name unchanged). Running +``ptxdist menuconfig`` will show it on top of all other menus entries. + +.. important:: + To be able to implement and test all the other required steps for adding + a new package, we first must enable the package for building. (Fine + tuning the menu can happen later on.) + + +The rule file skeleton still lacks some important information. Let’s +take a look into some of the top lines of the generated rule file +``./rules/foo.make``: + +.. code-block:: make + + FOO_VERSION := 1.1.0 + FOO_MD5 := + FOO := foo-$(FOO_VERSION) + FOO_SUFFIX := tar.gz + FOO_URL := http://www.foo.com/download/src/$(FOO).$(FOO_SUFFIX) + FOO_SOURCE := $(SRCDIR)/$(FOO).$(FOO_SUFFIX) + FOO_DIR := $(BUILDDIR)/$(FOO) + FOO_LICENSE := unknown + +We can find these lines with different content in most or all of the +other rule files PTXdist comes with. Up to the underline character is +always the package name and after the underline character is always +PTXdist specific. What does it mean: + +- ``*_VERSION`` brings in the version number of the release and is used + for the download and IPKG/OPKG package generation. + +- ``*_MD5`` to be sure the correct package has been downloaded, PTXdist + checks the given MD5 sum against the archive content. If both sums do + not match, PTXdist rejects the archive and fails the currently + running build. + +- ``*_SUFFIX`` defines the archive type, to make PTXdist choosing the + correct extracting tool. + +- ``*_URL`` defines the full qualified URL into the web for download. If + alternative download locations are known, they can be listed in this + variable, delimiter character is the space. + +- ``*_SOURCE`` tells PTXdist where to store the downloaded package. + +- ``*_DIR`` points to the directory this package will be built later on + by PTXdist. + +- ``*_LICENSE`` enables the user to get a list of licenses she/he is + using in her/his project (licenses of the enabled packages). + +After enabling the menu entry, we can start to check the *get* and +*extract* stages, calling them manually one after another. + +.. note:: The shown commands below expect that PTXdist downloads the + archives to a global directory named ``global_src``. This is not the + default setting, but we recommend to use a global directory to share all + archives between PTXdist based projects. Advantage is every download + happens only once. Refer to the ``setup`` command PTXdist provides. + +.. code-block:: text + + $ ptxdist get foo + + --------------------------- + target: foo-1.1.0.tar.gz + --------------------------- + + --2009-12-21 10:54:45-- http://www.foo.com/download/src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz + Length: 291190 (284K) [application/x-gzip] + Saving to: `/global_src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz.XXXXOGncZA' + + 100%[======================================>] 291,190 170K/s in 1.7s + + 2009-12-21 10:54:48 (170 KB/s) - `/global_src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz' saved [291190/291190] + +This command should start to download the source archive. If it fails, +we should check our network connection, proxy setup or if the given URL +in use is correct. + +.. note:: Sometimes we do not know the content of all the other variables in + the rule file. To get an idea what content a variable has, we can ask + PTXdist about it: + +.. code-block:: text + + $ ptxdist print FOO_URL + http://www.foo.com/download/src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz + +The next step would be to extract the archive. But as PTXdist checks the +MD5 sum in this case, this step will fail, because the ``FOO_MD5`` +variable is still empty. Let’s fill it: + +.. code-block:: text + + $ md5sum /global_src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz + 9a09840ab775a139ebb00f57a587b447 + +This string must be assigned to the FOO_MD5 in our new ``foo.make`` +rule file: + +.. code-block:: text + + FOO_MD5 := 9a09840ab775a139ebb00f57a587b447 + +We are now prepared for the next step: + +.. code-block:: text + + $ ptxdist extract foo + + ----------------------- + target: foo.extract + ----------------------- + + extract: archive=/global_src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz + extract: dest=/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target + PATCHIN: packet=foo-1.1.0 + PATCHIN: dir=/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0 + PATCHIN: no patches for foo-1.1.0 available + Fixing up /home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0/configure + finished target foo.extract + +In this example we expect an autotoolized source package. E.g. to +prepare the build, the archive comes with a ``configure`` script. This +is the default case for PTXdist. So, there is no need to modify the rule +file and we can simply run: + +.. code-block:: text + + $ ptxdist prepare foo + + ----------------------- + target: foo.prepare + ----------------------- + + [...] + + checking build system type... i686-host-linux-gnu + checking host system type... |ptxdistCompilerName| + checking whether to enable maintainer-specific portions of Makefiles... no + checking for a BSD-compatible install... /usr/bin/install -c + checking whether build environment is sane... yes + checking for a thread-safe mkdir -p... /bin/mkdir -p + checking for gawk... gawk + checking whether make sets $(MAKE)... yes + checking for |ptxdistCompilerName|-strip... |ptxdistCompilerName|-strip + checking for |ptxdistCompilerName|-gcc... |ptxdistCompilerName|-gcc + checking for C compiler default output file name... a.out + + [...] + + configure: creating ./config.status + config.status: creating Makefile + config.status: creating ppa_protocol/Makefile + config.status: creating config.h + config.status: executing depfiles commands + finished target foo.prepare + +At this stage things can fail: + +- A wrong or no MD5 sum was given + +- The ``configure`` script is not cross compile aware + +- The package depends on external components (libraries for example) + +If the ``configure`` script is not cross compile aware, we are out of +luck. We must patch the source archive in this case to make it work. +Refer to the section :ref:`configure_rebuild` on how to use +PTXdist’s features to simplify this task. +If the package depends on external components, these components might +be already part of PTXdist. In this case we just have to add this +dependency into the menu file and we are done. But if PTXdist cannot +fulfill this dependency, we also must add it as a separate package +first. + +If the *prepare* stage has finished successfully, the next step is to +compile the package. + +.. code-block:: text + + $ ptxdist compile foo + + ----------------------- + target: foo.compile + ----------------------- + + make[1]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' + make all-recursive + make[2]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' + make[3]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' + + [...] + + make[3]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' + make[2]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' + make[1]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' + finished target foo.compile + +At this stage things can fail: + +- The build system is not cross compile aware (it tries to execute just + created target binaries for example) + +- The package depends on external components (libraries for example) + not detected by ``configure`` + +- Sources are ignoring the endianness of some architectures or using + header files from the build host system (from ``/usr/include`` for + example) + +- The linker uses libraries from the build host system (from + ``/usr/lib`` for example) by accident + +In all of these cases we must patch the sources to make them work. Refer +to section :ref:`patching_packages` on how to use PTXdist’s +features to simplify this task. + +In this example we expect the best case: everything went fine, even for +cross compiling. So, we can continue with the next stage: *install* + +.. code-block:: text + + $ ptxdist install foo + + ----------------------- + target: foo.install + ----------------------- + + make[1]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' + make[2]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' + make[3]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' + test -z "/usr/bin" || /bin/mkdir -p "/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0/usr/bin" + /usr/bin/install -c 'foo' '/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0/usr/bin/foo' + make[3]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' + make[2]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' + make[1]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' + finished target foo.install + + ---------------------------- + target: foo.install.post + ---------------------------- + + finished target foo.install.post + +This *install* stage does not install anything to the target root +filesystem. It is mostly intended to install libraries and header files +other programs should link against later on. + +The last stage – *targetinstall* – is the one that defines the package’s +components to be forwarded to the target’s root filesystem. Due to the +absence of a generic way, this is the task of the developer. So, at this +point of time we must run our favourite editor again and modify our new +rule file ``./rules/foo.make``. + +The skeleton for the *targetinstall* stage looks like this: + +.. code-block:: make + + # ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- + # Target-Install + # ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- + + $(STATEDIR)/foo.targetinstall: + @$(call targetinfo) + + @$(call install_init, foo) + @$(call install_fixup, foo,PACKAGE,foo) + @$(call install_fixup, foo,PRIORITY,optional) + @$(call install_fixup, foo,VERSION,$(FOO_VERSION)) + @$(call install_fixup, foo,SECTION,base) + @$(call install_fixup, foo,AUTHOR,"My Name <me@my-org.com>") + @$(call install_fixup, foo,DEPENDS,) + @$(call install_fixup, foo,DESCRIPTION,missing) + + @$(call install_copy, foo, 0, 0, 0755, $(FOO_DIR)/foobar, /dev/null) + + @$(call install_finish, foo) + @$(call touch) + +The “header” of this stage defines some information IPKG needs. The +important part that we must modify is the call to the ``install_copy`` +macro (refer to section :ref:`reference_macros` for more details +about this kind of macros). This call instructs PTXdist to include the +given file (with UID, GID and permissions) into the IPKG, which means to +install this file to the target’s root filesystem. + +From the previous *install* stage we know this package installs an +executable called ``foo`` to location ``/usr/bin``. We can do the same +for our target by changing the *install\_copy* line to: + +.. code-block:: none + + @$(call install_copy, foo, 0, 0, 0755, $(FOO_DIR)/foo, /usr/bin/foo) + +To check it, we just run: + +.. code-block:: text + + $ ptxdist targetinstall foo + + ----------------------------- + target: foo.targetinstall + ----------------------------- + + install_init: preparing for image creation... + install_init: @ARCH@ -> i386 ... done + install_init: preinst not available + install_init: postinst not available + install_init: prerm not available + install_init: postrm not available + install_fixup: @PACKAGE@ -> foo ... done. + install_fixup: @PRIORITY@ -> optional ... done. + install_fixup: @VERSION@ -> 1.1.0 ... done. + install_fixup: @SECTION@ -> base ... done. + install_fixup: @AUTHOR@ -> "My Name <me\@my-org.com>" ... done. + install_fixup: @DESCRIPTION@ -> missing ... done. + install_copy: + src=/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0/foo + dst=/usr/bin/foo + owner=0 + group=0 + permissions=0755 + xpkg_finish: collecting license (unknown) ... done. + xpkg_finish: creating ipkg package ... done. + finished target foo.targetinstall + + ---------------------------------- + target: foo.targetinstall.post + ---------------------------------- + + finished target foo.targetinstall.post + +After this command, the target’s root filesystem contains a file called +``/usr/bin/foo`` owned by root, its group is also root and everyone has +execution permissions, but only the user root has write permissions. + +One last task of this port is still open: A reasonable location for +the new menu entry in PTXdist’s menu hierarchy. PTXdist arranges its +menus on the meaning of each package. Is it a network related tool? Or +a scripting language? Or a graphical application? +Each of these global meanings has its own submenu, where we can add +our new entry to. We just have to edit the head of our new menu file +``./rules/foo.in`` to add it to a specific global menu. If our new +package is a network related tool, the head of the menu file should +look like: + +.. code-block:: kconfig + + ## SECTION=networking + +We can grep through the other menu files from the PTXdist main +installation ``rules/`` directory to get an idea what section names are +available: + +.. code-block:: text + + rules/ $ find . -name \*.in | xargs grep "## SECTION" + ./acpid.in:## SECTION=shell_and_console + ./alsa-lib.in:## SECTION=system_libraries + ./alsa-utils.in:## SECTION=multimedia_sound + ./apache2.in:## SECTION=networking + ./apache2_mod_python.in:## SECTION=networking + [...] + ./xkeyboard-config.in:## SECTION=multimedia_xorg_data + ./xorg-app-xev.in:## SECTION=multimedia_xorg_app + ./xorg-app-xrandr.in:## SECTION=multimedia_xorg_app + ./host-eggdbus.in:## SECTION=hosttools_noprompt + ./libssh2.in:## SECTION=networking + +Porting a new package to PTXdist is (almost) finished now. + +To check it right away, we simply run these two commands: + +.. code-block:: text + + $ ptxdist clean foo + rm -rf /home/jbe/my_new_prj/state/foo.* + rm -rf /home/jbe/my_new_prj/packages/foo_* + rm -rf /home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0 + $ ptxdist targetinstall foo + + [...] + +.. important:: Discover somehow hidden dependencies with one more last check! + +Up to this point all the development of the new package was done in an already +built BSP. Doing so sometimes somehow hidden dependencies cannot be seen: +everything seems fine, the new package builds always successfully and the +results are working on the target. + +So to check for this kind of dependencies there is still one more final check +to do (even if its boring and takes time): + +.. code-block:: text + + $ ptxdist clean + [...] + $ ptxdist targetinstall foo + [...] + +This will re-start with a **clean** BSP and builds exactly the new package and +its (known) dependencies. If this builds successfully as well we are really done +with the new package. + +Some Notes about Licenses +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ + +The already mentioned rule variable ``*_LICENSE`` (e.g. ``FOO_LICENSE`` in our +example) is very important and must be filled by the developer of the package. +Many licenses bring in obligations using the corresponding package (*attribution* +for example). To make life easier for everybody the license for a package must +be provided. *SPDX* license identifiers unify the license names and are used +in PTXdist to identify license types and obligations. + +If a package comes with more than one license, all of their SPDX identifiers +must be listed and connected with the keyword ``AND``. If your package comes +with GPL-2.0 and LGPL-2.1 licenses, the definition should look like this: + +.. code-block:: make + + FOO_LICENSE := GPL-2.0 AND LGPL-2.1 + +One specific obligation cannot be detected examining the SPDX license identifiers +by PTXdist: *the license choice*. In this case all licenses of choice must be +listed and connected by the keyword ``OR``. + +If, for example, your obligation is to select one of the licenses *GPL-2.0* **or** +*GPL-3.0*, the ``*_LICENSE`` variable should look like this: + +.. code-block:: make + + FOO_LICENSE := GPL-2.0 OR GPL-3.0 + +SPDX License Identifiers +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +A list of SPDX license identifiers can be found here: + + https://spdx.org/licenses/ + +Help to Detect the Correct License +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +License identification isn't trivial. A help in doing so can be the following +repository and its content. It contains a list of known licenses based on their +SPDX identifier. The content is without formatting to simplify text search. + + https://github.com/spdx/license-list-data/tree/master/text + +Advanced Rule Files +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ + +The previous example on how to create a rule file sometimes works as +shown above. But most of the time source archives are not that simple. +In this section we want to give the user a more detailed selection how +the package will be built. + +Adding Static Configure Parameters +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +The ``configure`` scripts of various source archives provide additional +parameters to enable or disable features, or to configure them in a +specific way. + +We assume the ``configure`` script of our ``foo`` example (refer to +section :ref:`foo_example`) supports two additional parameters: + +- **--enable-debug**: Make the program more noisy. It’s disabled by + default. + +- **--with-bar**: Also build the special executable **bar**. Building + this executable is also disabled by default. + +We now want to forward these options to the ``configure`` script when it +runs in the *prepare* stage. To do so, we must again open the rule file +with our favourite editor and navigate to the *prepare* stage entry. + +PTXdist uses the variable ``FOO_CONF_OPT`` as the list of parameters to +be given to ``configure``. + +Currently this variable is commented out and defined to: + +.. code-block:: make + + # FOO_CONF_OPT := $(CROSS_AUTOCONF_USR) + +The variable ``CROSS_AUTOCONF_USR`` is predefined by PTXdist and +contains all basic parameters to instruct ``configure`` to prepare for a +**cross** compile environment. + +To use the two additional mentioned ``configure`` parameters, we comment +in this line and supplement this expression as follows: + +.. code-block:: make + + FOO_CONF_OPT := \ + $(CROSS_AUTOCONF_USR) \ + --enable-debug \ + --with-bar + +.. note:: We recommend to use this format with each parameter on a line of + its own. This format is easier to read and a diff shows more exactly any + change. + +To do a fast check if this addition was successful, we run: + +.. code-block:: text + + $ ptxdist print FOO_CONF_OPT + --prefix=/usr --sysconfdir=/etc --host=|ptxdistCompilerName| --build=i686-host-linux-gnu --enable-debug --with-bar + +.. note:: It depends on the currently selected platform and its architecture + what content this variable will have. The content shown above is an + example for a target. + +Or re-build the package with the new settings: + +.. code-block:: text + + $ ptxdist drop foo prepare + $ ptxdist targetinstall foo + +Adding Dynamic Configure Parameters +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +Sometimes it makes sense to add this kind of parameters on demand only; +especially a parameter like ``--enable-debug``. To let the user decide +if this parameter is to be used or not, we must add a menu entry. So, +let’s expand our menu. Here is its current content: + +.. code-block:: kconfig + + ## SECTION=project_specific + + config FOO + tristate + prompt "foo" + help + FIXME + +We’ll add two menu entries, one for each optional parameter we want to +add on demand to the ``configure`` parameters: + +.. code-block:: kconfig + + ## SECTION=project_specific + + config FOO + tristate + prompt "foo" + help + FIXME + + if FOO + config FOO_DEBUG + bool + prompt "add debug noise" + + config FOO_BAR + bool + prompt "build bar" + + endif + +.. important:: Always follow the rule to extend the base name by a suboption + name as the trailing part of the variable name. This gives PTXdist the ability + to detect a change in the package’s settings (via menuconfig) to force its + rebuild on demand. + +To make usage of the new menu entries, we must check them in the rule +file and add the correct parameters: + +.. code-block:: make + + # + # autoconf + # + FOO_CONF_OPT := \ + $(CROSS_AUTOCONF_USR) \ + --$(call ptx/endis, PTXCONF_FOO_DEBUG)-debug \ + --$(call ptx/wwo, PTXCONF_FOO_BAR)-bar + +.. important:: Please note the leading ``PTXCONF_`` for each define. While Kconfig is + using ``FOO_BAR``, the rule file must use ``PTXCONF_FOO_BAR`` instead. + +.. note:: Refer :ref:`Rule File Macro Reference <param_macros>` for further + details about these special kind of option macros (e.g. ``ptx/...``). + +It is a good practice to always add both settings, e.g. ``--disable-debug`` +even if this is the default case. Sometimes ``configure`` tries to guess +something and the binary result might differ depending on the build +order. For example some kind of package would also build some X related +tools, if X libraries are found. In this case it depends on the build +order, if the X related tools are built or not. All the autocheck +features are problematic here. So, if we do not want ``configure`` to +guess its settings we **must disable everything we do not want**. + +To support this process, PTXdist supplies a helper script, located at +``/path/to/ptxdist/scripts/configure-helper.py`` that compares the configure +output with the settings from ``FOO_CONF_OPT``: + +.. code-block:: text + + $ /opt/ptxdist-2017.06.0/scripts/configure-helper.py -p libsigrok + --- rules/libsigrok.make + +++ libsigrok-0.5.0 + @@ -4,3 +4,74 @@ + --libdir=/usr/lib + --build=x86_64-host-linux-gnu + --host=arm-v7a-linux-gnueabihf + + --enable-warnings=min|max|fatal|no + + --disable-largefile + + --enable-all-drivers + + --enable-agilent-dmm + [...] + + --enable-ruby + + --enable-java + + --without-libserialport + + --without-libftdi + + --without-libusb + + --without-librevisa + + --without-libgpib + + --without-libieee1284 + + --with-jni-include-path=DIR-LIST + +In this example, many configure options from libsigrok (marked with ``+``) +are not yet present in ``LIBSIGROK_CONF_OPT`` and must be added, possibly also +by providing more dynamic options in the package definition. + +If some parts of a package are built on demand only, they must also be +installed on demand only. Besides the *prepare* stage, we also must +modify our *targetinstall* stage: + +.. code-block:: make + + @$(call install_copy, foo, 0, 0, 0755, $(FOO_DIR)/foo, /usr/bin/foo) + + ifdef PTXCONF_FOO_BAR + @$(call install_copy, foo, 0, 0, 0755, $(FOO_DIR)/bar, /usr/bin/bar) + endif + + @$(call install_finish, foo) + @$(call touch) + +Now we can play with our new menu entries and check if they are working +as expected: + +.. code-block:: text + + $ ptxdist menuconfig + $ ptxdist targetinstall foo + +Whenever we change a *FOO* related menu entry, PTXdist should detect it +and re-build the package when a new build is started. + +.. _external_dependencies: + +Managing External Compile Time Dependencies +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +While running the prepare stage, it could happen that it fails due to a +missing external dependency. + +For example: + +.. code-block:: text + + checking whether zlib exists....failed + +In this example, our new package depends on the compression library +*zlib*. PTXdist comes with a target *zlib*. All we need to do in this +case is to declare that our new package *foo* depends on *zlib*. This +kind of dependency is managed in the menu file of our new package by +simply adding the ``select ZLIB`` line. After this addition our menu +file looks like: + +.. code-block:: kconfig + + ## SECTION=project_specific + + config FOO + tristate + select ZLIB + prompt "foo" + help + FIXME + + if FOO + config FOO_DEBUG + bool + prompt "add debug noise" + + config FOO_BAR + bool + prompt "build bar" + + endif + +PTXdist now builds the *zlib* first and our new package thereafter. + +Refer :ref:`external_dependencies_variants` for more specific dependency +description. + +Managing External Compile Time Dependencies on Demand +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +It is good practice to add only those dependencies that are really +required for the current configuration of the package. If the package +provides the features *foo* and *bar* and its ``configure`` provides +switches to enable/disable them independently, we can also add +dependencies on demand. Let’s assume feature *foo* needs the compression +library *libz* and *bar* needs the XML2 library *libxml2*. These +libraries are only required at run-time if the corresponding feature is +enabled. To add these dependencies on demand, the menu file looks like: + +.. code-block:: kconfig + + ## SECTION=project_specific + + config FOO + tristate + select ZLIB if FOO_FOO + select LIBXML2 if FOO_BAR + prompt "foo" + help + FIXME + + if FOO + config FOO_DEBUG + bool + prompt "add debug noise" + + config FOO_FOO + bool + prompt "build foo" + + config FOO_BAR + bool + prompt "build bar" + + endif + +.. important:: Do not add these ``select`` statements to the corresponding menu entry. + They must belong to the main menu entry of the package to ensure that + the calculation of the dependencies between the packages is done in a + correct manner. + +Managing External Runtime Dependencies +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +Some packages are building all of their components and also installing +them into the target’s sysroot. But only their *targetinstall* stage +decides which parts are copied to the root filesystem. So, compiling and +linking of our package will work, because everything required is found +in the target’s sysroot. + +In our example there is a hidden dependency to the math library +``libm``. Our new package was built successfully, because the linker was +able to link our binaries against the ``libm`` from the toolchain. But +in this case the ``libm`` must also be available in the target’s root +filesystem to fulfil the run-time dependency: We have to force PTXdist to +install ``libm``. ``libm`` is part of the *glibc* package, but is not +installed by default (to keep the root filesystem small). So, it **does +not** help to select the ``GLIBC`` symbol, to get a ``libm`` at run-time. + +The correct solution here is to add a ``select LIBC_M`` to our menu +file. With all the additions above it now looks like: + +.. code-block:: kconfig + + ## SECTION=project_specific + + config FOO + tristate + select ZLIB if FOO_FOO + select LIBXML2 if FOO_BAR + select LIBC_M + prompt "foo" + help + FIXME + + if FOO + config FOO_DEBUG + bool + prompt "add debug noise" + + config FOO_FOO + bool + prompt "build foo" + + config FOO_BAR + bool + prompt "build bar" + + endif + +.. note:: There are other packages around, that do not install everything by + default. If our new package needs something special, we must take a look + into the menu of the other package how to force the required components + to be installed and add the corresponding ``selects`` to our own menu + file. In this case it does not help to enable the required parts in our + project configuration, because this has no effect on the build order! + +Managing Plain Makefile Packages +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +Many packages are still coming with a plain ``Makefile``. The user has +to adapt it to make it work in a cross compile environment as well. +PTXdist can also handle this kind of packages. We only have to specify +a special *prepare* and *compile* stage. + +Such packages often have no special need for any kind of preparation. In +this we must instruct PTXdist to do nothing in the *prepare* stage: + +.. code-block:: make + + FOO_CONF_TOOL := NO + +To compile the package, we can use ``make``\ ’s feature to overwrite +variables used in the ``Makefile``. With this feature we can still use +the original ``Makefile`` but with our own (cross compile) settings. + +Most of the time the generic compile rule can be used, only a few +settings are required. For a well defined ``Makefile`` it is sufficient to +set up the correct cross compile environment for the *compile* stage: + +.. code-block:: make + + FOO_MAKE_ENV := $(CROSS_ENV) + +``make`` will be called in this case with: + +``$(FOO_MAKE_ENV) $(MAKE) -C $(FOO_DIR) $(FOO_MAKE_OPT)`` + +So, in the rule file only the two variables ``FOO_MAKE_ENV`` and +``FOO_MAKE_OPT`` must be set, to forward the required settings to the +package’s buildsystem. If the package cannot be built in parallel, we +can also add the ``FOO_MAKE_PAR := NO``. ``YES`` is the default. + +Managing CMake/QMake/Meson Packages +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +Building packages that use ``cmake``, ``qmake`` or ``meson`` is much like +building packages with an autotools based buildsystem. We need to specify +the configuration tool: + +.. code-block:: make + + FOO_CONF_TOOL := cmake + +or + +.. code-block:: make + + FOO_CONF_TOOL := qmake + +or respectively + +.. code-block:: make + + FOO_CONF_TOOL := meson + +And provide the correct configuration options. The syntax is different so +PTXdist provides additional macros to simplify configurable features. +For ``cmake`` the configuration options typically look like this: + +.. code-block:: make + + FOO_CONF_OPT := \ + $(CROSS_CMAKE_USR) \ + -DBUILD_TESTS:BOOL=OFF \ + -DENABLE_BAR:BOOL=$(call ptx/onoff, PTXCONF_FOO_BAR) + +For ``qmake`` the configuration options typically look like this: + +.. code-block:: make + + FOO_CONF_OPT := \ + $(CROSS_QMAKE_OPT) \ + PREFIX=/usr + +And for ``meson`` the configuration options typically look like this: + +.. code-block:: make + + FOO_CONF_OPT := \ + $(CROSS_MESON_USR) \ + -Dbar=$(call ptx/truefalse,PTXCONF_FOO_BAR) + +Please note that currently only host and target ``cmake``\/``meson`` packages +and only target ``qmake`` packages are supported. + +Managing Python Packages +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +As with any other package, the correct configuration tool must be selected +for Python packages: + +.. code-block:: make + + FOO_CONF_TOOL := python + +.. note:: For Python3 packages the value must be ``python3``. + +No Makefiles are used when building Python packages so the usual ``make`` +and ``make install`` for the *compile* and *install* stages cannot be used. +PTXdist will call ``python setup.py build`` and ``python setup.py install`` +instead. + +.. note:: *FOO* is still the name of our example package. It must be + replaced by the real package name. + + +.. _patching_packages: + +Patching Packages +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ + +There can be various reasons why a package must be patched: + +- Package is broken for cross compile environments + +- Package is broken within a specific feature + +- Package is vulnerable and needs some fixes + +- or anything else (this case is the most common one) + +Ideally, those problems should be addressed in the original project, +so any patches you add to your BSP or to PTXdist should also be submitted upstream. +The upstream project can often provide better feedback, they can integrate your +patch into a new release, and also maintain your changes as part of the project. +This way we make sure that all advantages of the open source idea work for us; +and your patch can be removed again later when a new release of the project is +integrated into your BSP or into PTXdist. + +PTXdist handles patching automatically. +After extracting the archive of a package, PTXdist checks for the existence of +a patch directory named like its ``<PKG>_PATCHES`` variable, or, if this variable +is not set, like its ``<PKG>`` variable. +The patch directory is then searched in all locations listed by the +``PTXDIST_PATH_PATCHES`` variable, and the first one found is used. +Take an exemplary package ``foo`` with version ``1.1.0``: +The variable ``FOO`` will have the value ``foo-1.1.0``, so PTXdist will look for +a patch directory named ``foo-1.1.0`` in the following locations: + +#. the current layer: + + a. project (``./patches/foo-1.1.0``) + b. platform (``./configs/|ptxdistPlatformConfigDir|/patches/foo-1.1.0``) + +#. any :ref:`base layers <layers-in-ptxdist>`, + applying the same search order as above for each layer recursively + +#. ptxdist (``<ptxdist/installation/path>/patches/foo-1.1.0``) + +The patches from the first location found are used. Note: Due to this +search order, a PTXdist project can replace global patches from the +PTXdist installation. This can be useful if a project sticks to a +specific PTXdist revision but fixes from a more recent revision of +PTXdist should be used. + +PTXdist uses the utilities *git*, *patch* or *quilt* to work with +patches or patch series. We recommend *git*, as it can manage patch +series in a very easy way. + +Creating a Patch Series for a Package +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +To create a patch series for the first time, we can run the following +steps. We are still using our *foo-1.1.0* example package here: + +Using Quilt +""""""""""" + +We create a special directory for the patch series in the local project +directory: + +.. code-block:: text + + $ mkdir -p patches/foo-1.1.0 + +PTXdist expects a ``series`` file in the patch directory and at least +one patch. Otherwise it fails. Due to the fact that we do not have any +patch content yet, we’ll start with a dummy entry in the ``series`` file +and an empty ``patch`` file. + +.. code-block:: text + + $ touch patches/foo-1.1.0/dummy + $ echo dummy > patches/foo-1.1.0/series + +Next is to extract the package (if already done, we must remove it +first): + +.. code-block:: text + + $ ptxdist extract foo + +This will extract the archive and create a symbolic link in the build +directory pointing to our local patch directory. Working this way will +ensure that we do not lose our created patches if we enter +``ptxdist clean foo`` by accident. In our case the patches are still +present in ``patches/foo-1.1.0`` and can be used the next time we +extract the package again. + +All we have to do now is to do the modification we need to make the +package work. We change into the build directory and use quilt_ to +create new patches, add files to respective patches, modify these files +and refresh the patches to save our changes. +See the *quilt* documentation (``man 1 quilt``) for more information. + +.. note:: For patches that are intended for PTXdist upstream use the git + workflow described below to get proper patch headers. + +.. _quilt: http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/quilt + +Using Git +""""""""" + +Create the patch directory like above for *quilt*, +but only add an empty series file: + +.. code-block:: text + + $ mkdir -p patches/foo-1.1.0 + $ touch patches/foo-1.1.0/series + +Then extract the package with an additional command line switch: + +.. code-block:: text + + $ ptxdist --git extract foo + +The empty series file makes PTXdist create a Git repository in the +respective package build directory, +and import the package source as the first commit. + +.. note:: Optionally, you can enable the setting *Developer Options → + use git to apply patches* in `ptxdist setup` to get this behaviour + as a default for every package. + However, note that this setting is meant for development only, and can lead + to failures – some packages try to determine if they are being compiled from + a Git source tree, and behave differently in that case. + +Then you can change into the package build directory +(``platform-<name>/build-target/foo-1.1.0``), +patch the required source files, +and make Git commits on the way. +The Git history should now look something like this: + +.. code-block:: text + + $ git log --oneline --decorate + * df343e821851 (HEAD -> master) Makefile: don't build the tests + * 65a360c2bd60 strfry.c: frobnicate the excusator + * fdc315f6844c (tag: foobar-1.1.0, tag: base) initial commit + +Finally, call ``git ptx-patches`` to transform those Git commits into the patch +series in the ``patches/foo-1.1.0`` folder. +This way they don't get lost when cleaning the package. + +.. note:: PTXdist will only create a Git repository for packages with + patches. To use Git to generate the first patch, create an empty series + file ``patches/foobar-1.1.0/series`` before extracting the packages. This + will tell PTXdist to use Git anyways and ``git ptx-patches`` will put the + patches there. + +Both approaches (Git and quilt) are not suitable for modifying files +that are autogenerated in autotools-based buildsystems. +Refer to the section :ref:`configure_rebuild` on how PTXdist can +handle this special task. + +Adding More Patches to a Package +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +If we want to add more patches to an already patched package, we can use +nearly the same way as creating patches for the first time. But if the +patch series comes from the PTXdist main installation, we do not have +write permissions to these directories (do NEVER work on the main +installation directories, NEVER, NEVER, NEVER). Due to the search order +in which PTXdist searches for patches for a specific package, we can +copy the global patch series to our local project directory. Now we have +the permissions to add more patches or modify the existing ones. Also +*quilt* and *git* are our friends here to manage the patch series. + +If we think that our new patches are valuable also for others, or they +fix an error, it could be a good idea to send these patches to PTXdist +mainline, and to the upstream project too. + + +.. _configure_rebuild: + +Modifying Autotoolized Packages +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +Autotoolized packages are very picky when automatically generated files +get patched. The patch order is very important in this case and +sometimes it even fails and nobody knows why. + +To improve a package’s autotools-based build system, PTXdist comes with +its own project local autotools to regenerate the autotools template +files, instead of patching them. With this feature, only the template +files must be patched, the required ``configure`` script and the +``Makefile.in`` files are regenerated in the final stages of the +*prepare* step. + +This feature works like the regular patching mechanism. The only +difference is the additional ``autogen.sh`` file in the patch directory. +If it exists and has execution permissions, it will be called after the +package was patched (while the *extract* stage is running). + +Its content depends on developer needs; for the most simple case the +content can be: + +.. code-block:: bash + + #!/bin/bash + + aclocal $ACLOCAL_FLAGS + + libtoolize \ + --force \ + --copy + + autoreconf \ + --force \ + --install \ + --warnings=cross \ + --warnings=syntax \ + --warnings=obsolete \ + --warnings=unsupported + +.. note:: In this way not yet autotoolized package can be autotoolized. We + just have to add the common autotool template files (``configure.ac`` + and ``Makefile.am`` for example) via a patch series to the package + source and the ``autogen.sh`` to the patch directory. diff --git a/doc/dev_create_new_pkg_templates.rst b/doc/dev_create_new_pkg_templates.rst new file mode 100644 index 000000000..d7c2927b6 --- /dev/null +++ b/doc/dev_create_new_pkg_templates.rst @@ -0,0 +1,77 @@ +Creating New Package Templates +------------------------------ + +For larger projects it can be convenient to have project specific package +templates. This can be achieved by either modifying existing templates or +by creating completely new templates. + +Modifying a Template +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ + +A template can be modified by providing new input files. This is easier +than creating a new template but does not allow to specify new variables to +substitute in the input files. + +PTXdist looks for template files the same way it looks for rules files. The +only difference is, that it searches in the ``templates/`` subdirectory. +So a modified ``./rules/templates/template-target-make`` can be used to +tweak the ``target`` template. + +Creating a New Template +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ + +For a completely new template, some bash scripting is required. All shell +code must be placed in a file named like this: +``./scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_*.sh``. + +The minimum requirement for a new template is: +- a shell function that creates the new package +- registering the new template + +.. code-block:: sh + + ptxd_template_new_mypkg() { + # create the package here + } + export -f ptxd_template_new_mypkg + ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="mypkg" + ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="create awesome mypkg package" + +PTXdist provides several helper functions to simplify the template. +Using those functions, the package creation process is split into two +parts: + +- query the user for input and export variables. +- create the new package files from the template source files by + substituting all instances of ``@<variable>@`` with the value of the + corresponding variable. + +A simple template function could look like this: + +.. code-block:: sh + + ptxd_template_new_mypkg() { + ptxd_template_read_basic && + ptxd_template_read "enter download section" DL_SECTION "foobar" + ptxd_template_read_author && + export section="local_${dlsection}" && + ptxd_template_write_rules + } + +This template requires ``rules/templates/template-mypkg-make`` and +``rules/templates/template-mypkg-in`` as source files. They could be +derived from the ``target`` template with a simple modification: + +.. code-block:: make + + @PACKAGE@_SUFFIX := tar.xz + @PACKAGE@_URL := http://dl.my-company.local/downloads/@DL_SECTION@/$(@PACKAGE@).$(@PACKAGE@_SUFFIX) + +The helper functions that are used in the example above are defined in +``scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh`` in the PTXdist source tree. + +The template is a normal shell function. Arbitrary things can be done here +to create the new package. The helper functions are just the most +convenient way to crate simple templates. It is also possible to create +more files. For examples, the builtin ``genimage`` template creates a extra +config file for the new package. diff --git a/doc/dev_dir_hierarchy.rst b/doc/dev_dir_hierarchy.rst new file mode 100644 index 000000000..bd1ad40d0 --- /dev/null +++ b/doc/dev_dir_hierarchy.rst @@ -0,0 +1,108 @@ +.. _directory_hierarchy: + +PTXdist’s Directory Hierarchy +----------------------------- + +.. note:: Referenced directories are meant relative to the PTXdist main + installation location (if not otherwise stated). If not configured + differently, this main path is ``/usr/local/lib/ptxdist-|ptxdistVendorVersion|`` + +Rule Files +~~~~~~~~~~ + +When building a single package, PTXdist needs the information on how to +handle the package, i.e. on how to get it from the source up to what the +target needs at run-time. This information is provided by a rule file per +package. + +PTXdist collects all rule files in its ``rules/`` directory. Whenever +PTXdist builds something, all these rule files are scanned at once. +These rule files are global rule files, valid for all projects. PTXdist +uses a mechanism to be able to add or replace specific rule files on a +per project base. If a ``rules/`` directory exists in the current +project, its content is scanned too. These project local rule files are +used in addition to the global rule files or – if they are using the +same name as a global rule file – **replacing** the global rule file. + +The replacing mechanism can be used to extend or adapt packages for +specific project requirements. Or it can be used for bug fixing by +backporting rule files from more recent PTXdist revisions to projects +that are stuck to an older PTXdist revision for maintenance only. + +Patch Series +~~~~~~~~~~~~ + +There are many packages in the wild that are not cross build aware. They +fail compiling some files, use wrong include paths or try to link +against host libraries. To be successful in the embedded world, these +types of failures must be fixed. If required, PTXdist provides such +fixes per package. They are organized in *patch series* and can be found +in a ``patches/`` directory within a subdirectory using the same name +as the package itself. + +PTXdist uses the utility ``patch`` or ``quilt`` (or ``git`` on demand) to apply +an existing patch series after extracting the archive. So, every patch series +contains a set of patches and one ``series`` file to define the order in +which the patches must be applied. + +.. note:: Patches can be compressed. + +Patches are looked for at several locations: + +1. the ``patches/`` folder in your BSP (``${PTXDIST_WORKSPACE}/patches``) + +2. the folder ``patches/`` folder relative to your selected platformconfig + file (``${PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR}/patches``). If your platformconfig + file is at ``configs/|ptxdistPlatformConfigDir|/platformconfig``, this + patch folder will be ``configs/|ptxdistPlatformConfigDir|/patches/``. + +3. the ``patches/`` folder in PTXdist's main installation directory + (``${PTXDIST_TOPDIR}/patches``) + +The list is tried from first to last. +If no patches were found in one of the locations, the next location is tried. +When all locations have been tried unsuccessfully, the package is not patched. + +This search order can be used to use specific patch series for specific +cases. + +- platform specific + +- project specific + +- common case + +- bug fixing + +The *bug fixing* case is used in accordance to a replacement of a rule +file. If this was done due to a backport, and the more recent PTXdist +revision does not only exchange the rule file but also the patch series, +this mechanism ensures that both relevant parts can be updated in the +project. + +Runtime Configuration +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ + +Many packages are using run-time configuration files along with their +executables and libraries. PTXdist provides default configuration files +for the most common cases. These files can be found in the +``projectroot/etc`` directory and they are using the same names as the ones +at run-time (and their install directory on the target side will also be +``/etc``). + +But some of these default configuration files are empty, due to the +absence of a common case. The project must provide replacements of these +files with a more useful content in every case where the (empty) default +one does not meet the target’s requirements. + +PTXdist first searches in the local project directory for a specific +configuration file and falls back to use the default one if none exists +locally. Refer section :ref:`install_alternative` for further +details in which order and locations PTXdist searches for these kind of files. + +A popular example is the configuration file ``/etc/fstab``. The default +one coming with PTXdist works for the most common cases. But if our +project requires a special setup, we can just copy the default one to +the local ``./projectroot/etc/fstab``, modify it and we are done. The +next time PTXdist builds the root filesystem it will use the local +``fstab`` instead of the global (default) one. diff --git a/doc/dev_layers_in_ptxdist.rst b/doc/dev_layers_in_ptxdist.rst new file mode 100644 index 000000000..ec92c8c8a --- /dev/null +++ b/doc/dev_layers_in_ptxdist.rst @@ -0,0 +1,111 @@ +.. _layers-in-ptxdist: + +Layers in PTXdist +----------------- + +For better maintenance or other reasons, a PTXdist project can be split +into multiple layers. Each layer has exactly the same directory hierarchy +as described in :ref:`directory_hierarchy` and other chapters. + +All layers are explicitly stacked in the filesystem. The top layer is the +workspace of the PTXdist project. Any ``selected_*`` links and the platform +build directory are created here. The layer below is defined by the +subdirectory or symlink named ``base/``. More can be stacked the same +way, so ``base/base/`` is the third layer and so on. +In many ways, PTXdist itself can be considered as the bottom layer. This is +either implicit or explicit with one last ``base/`` symlink. + +A project can overwrite files provided by PTXdist in many different ways, +e.g. rule files or files installed with :ref:`install_alternative` etc. +This concept expands naturally to layers. Each layer can overwrite files +provided by lower layers in the exact same way. Any files are always +searched for in a strict layer by layer order. + +Writing Layer Aware Rules +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ + +For the most part, package rules work just as expected when multiple layers +are used. Any layer specific handling is done implicitly by PTXdist. +However, there are a few things that need special handling. + +The variables :ref:`PTXDIST_WORKSPACE<ptxdist_workspace>` and +:ref:`PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR`<ptxdist_platformconfigdir>` always refer +to the directories in the top layer. These variables might be used in rules +files like this: + +.. code-block:: make + + MY_KERNEL_CONFIG := $(PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR)/kernelconfig.special + +If the referenced file is in any layer but the top one then it will not +be found. To handle use-cases like this, the macros :ref:`in_path` and +:ref:`in_platformconfigdir` can be used: + +.. code-block:: make + + MY_KERNEL_CONFIG := $(call ptx/in-platformconfigdir, kernelconfig.special) + +This way, the layers are searched top to bottom until the config file is +found. + +PTXdist Config Files with Multiple Layers +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ + +In many cases a layer may want to modify the **ptxconfig** by enabling or +disabling some options. Any changes must be propagated through the whole +layer stack. + +The features and workflow described here apply to the **ptxconfig**, the +**platformconfig** and any **collectionconfig** used in the project. + +To do this, PTXdist stores a delta config to the layer below and a full +config file in each layer. If the two files are missing then the config is +unchanged. The bottom layer has only the config file and no delta. + +At runtime, PTXdist will always use the full config file in the top layer +where the config exists. Before doing so, it will ensure that the config is +consistent across all layers. This means that, for any layer that contains a +delta config, the full config file of the layer below has not changed since +the delta config was last updated. If any inconsistency is detected, +PTXdist will abort. + +For any command that modifies the config file, except ``oldconfig``, +PTXdist will use kconfig implicitly on all layers to check if the config +for this layer is up to date. This is a stricter check than the consistency +validation. For example, if a new package was added to a layer without +updating the **ptxconfig** then this will be detected and PTXdist will +abort. If all other layers are up to date, then PTXdist will use the delta +config of the top layer, apply it to the full config of the layer below +and execute the specified command with the resulting config file. + +.. note:: If the config file does not exist yet on the top layer, then it + will be created if changes to the config are made. Similarly the config + will be deleted if the delta is empty after the changes. In either case + it may be necessary to update any ``selected_*`` link to point to the + correct config. + +If PTXdist detects an inconsistency or an out of date config file then it +must be updated before they can be used. This can be done by using the +``oldconfig`` command. In this special case, PTXdist will iterate from the +bottom to the top layer and run ``oldconfig`` for each of them. It will +use the delta config applied to the full config of the layer below at each +step. This means that it's possible to enable or disable a option in the +bottom layer and ``oldconfig`` will propagate this change to all other +layers. + +Packages with kconfig Based Config Files +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ + +For packages such as the Linux kernel that have kconfig based config files, +a lot of the infrastructure to handle config files and deltas across +multiple layers can be reused. Consistency validation is done implicitly +and ``menuconfig`` and other kconfig commands will use config files and +deltas as expected. + +It's not possible to implicitly run ``oldconfig`` on other layers (this may +require a different source tree for the packages), so any inconsistencies +must be resolved manually by running ``oldconfig`` explicitly on each +layer. + +The make macros that provide these features are currently used by the +barebox and kernel packages and templates. diff --git a/doc/dev_manual.rst b/doc/dev_manual.rst index 50827b6a9..47a77a9be 100644 --- a/doc/dev_manual.rst +++ b/doc/dev_manual.rst @@ -5,1758 +5,12 @@ PTXdist Developer’s Manual This chapter shows all (or most) of the details of how PTXdist works. -- where are the files stored that PTXdist uses when building packages - -- how patching works - -- where is PTXdist fetching a package’s run-time configuration files - from - -- how to control a package’s build stages - -- how to add new packages - -.. _directory_hierarchy: - -PTXdist’s Directory Hierarchy ------------------------------ - -.. note:: Referenced directories are meant relative to the PTXdist main - installation location (if not otherwise stated). If not configured - differently, this main path is ``/usr/local/lib/ptxdist-|ptxdistVendorVersion|`` - -Rule Files -~~~~~~~~~~ - -When building a single package, PTXdist needs the information on how to -handle the package, i.e. on how to get it from the source up to what the -target needs at run-time. This information is provided by a rule file per -package. - -PTXdist collects all rule files in its ``rules/`` directory. Whenever -PTXdist builds something, all these rule files are scanned at once. -These rule files are global rule files, valid for all projects. PTXdist -uses a mechanism to be able to add or replace specific rule files on a -per project base. If a ``rules/`` directory exists in the current -project, its content is scanned too. These project local rule files are -used in addition to the global rule files or – if they are using the -same name as a global rule file – **replacing** the global rule file. - -The replacing mechanism can be used to extend or adapt packages for -specific project requirements. Or it can be used for bug fixing by -backporting rule files from more recent PTXdist revisions to projects -that are stuck to an older PTXdist revision for maintenance only. - -Patch Series -~~~~~~~~~~~~ - -There are many packages in the wild that are not cross build aware. They -fail compiling some files, use wrong include paths or try to link -against host libraries. To be successful in the embedded world, these -types of failures must be fixed. If required, PTXdist provides such -fixes per package. They are organized in *patch series* and can be found -in a ``patches/`` directory within a subdirectory using the same name -as the package itself. - -PTXdist uses the utility ``patch`` or ``quilt`` (or ``git`` on demand) to apply -an existing patch series after extracting the archive. So, every patch series -contains a set of patches and one ``series`` file to define the order in -which the patches must be applied. - -.. note:: Patches can be compressed. - -Patches are looked for at several locations: - -1. the ``patches/`` folder in your BSP (``${PTXDIST_WORKSPACE}/patches``) - -2. the folder ``patches/`` folder relative to your selected platformconfig - file (``${PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR}/patches``). If your platformconfig - file is at ``configs/|ptxdistPlatformConfigDir|/platformconfig``, this - patch folder will be ``configs/|ptxdistPlatformConfigDir|/patches/``. - -3. the ``patches/`` folder in PTXdist's main installation directory - (``${PTXDIST_TOPDIR}/patches``) - -The list is tried from first to last. -If no patches were found in one of the locations, the next location is tried. -When all locations have been tried unsuccessfully, the package is not patched. - -This search order can be used to use specific patch series for specific -cases. - -- platform specific - -- project specific - -- common case - -- bug fixing - -The *bug fixing* case is used in accordance to a replacement of a rule -file. If this was done due to a backport, and the more recent PTXdist -revision does not only exchange the rule file but also the patch series, -this mechanism ensures that both relevant parts can be updated in the -project. - -Runtime Configuration -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ - -Many packages are using run-time configuration files along with their -executables and libraries. PTXdist provides default configuration files -for the most common cases. These files can be found in the -``projectroot/etc`` directory and they are using the same names as the ones -at run-time (and their install directory on the target side will also be -``/etc``). - -But some of these default configuration files are empty, due to the -absence of a common case. The project must provide replacements of these -files with a more useful content in every case where the (empty) default -one does not meet the target’s requirements. - -PTXdist first searches in the local project directory for a specific -configuration file and falls back to use the default one if none exists -locally. Refer section :ref:`install_alternative` for further -details in which order and locations PTXdist searches for these kind of files. - -A popular example is the configuration file ``/etc/fstab``. The default -one coming with PTXdist works for the most common cases. But if our -project requires a special setup, we can just copy the default one to -the local ``./projectroot/etc/fstab``, modify it and we are done. The -next time PTXdist builds the root filesystem it will use the local -``fstab`` instead of the global (default) one. - -.. _adding_new_packages: - -Adding New Packages -------------------- - -PTXdist provides a huge amount of applications sufficient for the most -embedded use cases. But there is still need for some fancy new packages. -This section describes the steps and the background on how to integrate -new packages into the project. - -At first a summary about possible application types which PTXdist can -handle: - -- **host type**: This kind of package is built to run on the build - host. Most of the time such a package is needed if another - target-relevant package needs to generate some data. For example the - *glib* package depends on its own to create some data. But if it is - compiled for the target, it can’t do so. That’s why a host glib - package is required to provide these utilities runnable on the build - host. It sounds strange to build a host package, even if on the build - host such utilities are already installed. But this way ensures that - there are no dependencies regarding the build host system. - -- **target type**: This kind of package is built for the target. - -- **cross type**: This kind of package is built for the build host, but - creates architecture specific data for the target. - -- **src-autoconf-prog**: This kind of package is built for the target. - It is intended for development, as it does not handle a released - archive but a plain source project instead. Creating such a package - will also create a small autotools based source template project on - demand to give the developer an easy point to start. This template is - prepared to build a single executable program. For further details refer - section :ref:`adding_src_autoconf_exec`. - -- **src-autoconf-lib**: This kind of package is built for the target. - It is intended for development, as it does not handle a released - archive but a plain source project instead. Creating such a package - will also create a small autotools/libtool based source template - project on demand to give the developer an easy point to start. This - template is prepared to build a single shared library. For further - details refer section :ref:`adding_src_autoconf_lib`. - -- **src-autoconf-proglib**: This kind of package is built for the - target. It is intended for development, as it does not handle a - released archive but a plain source project instead. Creating such a - package will also create a small autotools/libtool based template - project on demand to give the developer an easy point to start. This - template is prepared to build a single shared library and a single - executable program. The program will be linked against the shared - library. For further details refer section :ref:`adding_src_autoconf_exec_lib`. - -- **file**: This kind of package is intended to add a few simple files - into the build process. We assume these files do not need any - processing, they are ready to use and must only be present in the - build process or at run-time (HTML files for example). Refer to the - section :ref:`adding_files` for further details on how to use - it. - -- **src-make-prog**: This kind of package is built for the target. It’s - intended for development, as it does not handle a released archive - but a plain source project instead. Creating such a package will also - create a simple makefile-based template project the developer can use - as a starting point for development. - -- **src-cmake-prog**: This kind of package is built for the target. - It’s intended for developments based on the *cmake* buildsystem. - Various projects are using *cmake* instead of *make* and can be built - with this package type. PTXdist will prepare it to compile sources in - accordance to the target libraries and their settings. Creating such - a package will also create a simple template project to be used as a - starting point for development. - -- **src-qmake-prog**: This kind of package is built for the target. - It’s intended for developments based on the *qmake* buildsystem. If - the developer is going to develop a QT based application, this rule - is prepared to compile sources in accordance to the target libraries - and their settings. Creating such a package will also create a simple - template project to be used as a starting point for development. - -- **src-meson-prog**: This kind of package is built for the target. - It’s intended for developments based on the *meson* buildsystem. - Various projects are using *meson* today and can be built - with this package type. PTXdist will prepare it to compile sources in - accordance to the target libraries and their settings. Creating such - a package will also create a simple template project to be used as a - starting point for development. - -- **font**: This package is a helper to add X font files to the root - filesystem. This package does not create an additional IPKG, instead - it adds the font to the existing font IPKG. This includes the - generation of the directory index files, required by the Xorg - framework to recognize the font file. - -- **src-linux-driver**: This kind of package builds an out of tree - kernel driver. It also creates a driver template to give the - developer an easy point to start. - -- **kernel**: PTXdist comes with the ability to handle one kernel in its - platform. This type of package enables us to handle more than one kernel in - the project. - -- **barebox**: PTXdist comes with the ability to handle one bootloader in its - platform. This type of package enables us to handle more than one bootloader - in the project. - -- **image-tgz**: This kind of package creates a tar ball from a list of - packages. It is often uses as an input for other image packages. - -- **image-genimage**: This kind of package can handle all kind of image - generation for almost every target independent of its complexity. - -- **blspec-entry**: PTXdist comes with the ability to handle one bootspec in its - platform. This type of package enables us to handle more than one bootspec - in the project. - -.. _foo_example: - -Rule File Creation -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ - -To create such a new package, we create a project local ``rules/`` -directory first. Then we run - -.. code-block:: text - - $ ptxdist newpackage <package type> - -If we omit the <``package type``\ >, PTXdist will list all available -package types. - -In our first example, we want to add a new target type archive package. -When running the - -.. code-block:: text - - $ ptxdist newpackage target - -command, PTXdist asks a few questions about this package. This -information is the basic data PTXdist must know about the package. - -.. code-block:: text - - ptxdist: creating a new 'target' package: - - ptxdist: enter package name.......: foo - ptxdist: enter version number.....: 1.1.0 - ptxdist: enter URL of basedir.....: http://www.foo.com/download/src - ptxdist: enter suffix.............: tar.gz - ptxdist: enter package author.....: My Name <me@my-org.com> - ptxdist: enter package section....: project_specific - -What we have to answer: - -- **package name**: As this kind of package handles a source archive, - the correct answer here is the basename of the archive’s file name. - If its full name is ``foo-1.1.0.tar.gz``, then ``foo`` is the - basename to enter here. - -- **version number**: Most source archives are using a release or - version number in their file name. If its full name is - ``foo-1.1.0.tar.gz``, then ``1.1.0`` is the version number to enter - here. - -- **URL of basedir**: This URL tells PTXdist where to download the - source archive from the web (if not already done). If the full URL to - download the archive is - ``http://www.foo.com/download/src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz``, the basedir - part ``http://www.foo.com/download/src`` is to be entered here. - -- **suffix**: Archives are using various formats for distribution. - PTXdist uses the *suffix* entry to select the matching extraction - tool. If the archive’s full name is ``foo-1.1.0.tar.gz``, then - ``tar.gz`` is the suffix to enter here. - -- **package author**: If we intend to contribute this new package to - PTXdist mainline, we should add our name here. This name will be used - in the copyright note of the rule file and will also be added to the - generated ipkg. When you run ``ptxdist setup`` prior to this call, - you can enter your name and your email address, so PTXdist will use - it as the default (very handy if you intend to add many new - packages). - -- **package section**: We can enter here the menu section name where - our new package menu entry should be listed. In the first step we can - leave the default name unchanged. It’s a string in the menu file - only, so changing it later on is still possible. - -Make it Work -~~~~~~~~~~~~ - -Generating the rule file is only one of the required steps to get a new -package. The next steps to make it work are to check if all stages are -working as expected and to select the required parts to get them -installed in the target root filesystem. Also we must find a reasonable -location where to add our new menu entry to configure the package. - -The generated skeleton starts to add the new menu entry in the main -configure menu (if we left the section name unchanged). Running -``ptxdist menuconfig`` will show it on top of all other menus entries. - -.. important:: - To be able to implement and test all the other required steps for adding - a new package, we first must enable the package for building. (Fine - tuning the menu can happen later on.) - - -The rule file skeleton still lacks some important information. Let’s -take a look into some of the top lines of the generated rule file -``./rules/foo.make``: - -.. code-block:: make - - FOO_VERSION := 1.1.0 - FOO_MD5 := - FOO := foo-$(FOO_VERSION) - FOO_SUFFIX := tar.gz - FOO_URL := http://www.foo.com/download/src/$(FOO).$(FOO_SUFFIX) - FOO_SOURCE := $(SRCDIR)/$(FOO).$(FOO_SUFFIX) - FOO_DIR := $(BUILDDIR)/$(FOO) - FOO_LICENSE := unknown - -We can find these lines with different content in most or all of the -other rule files PTXdist comes with. Up to the underline character is -always the package name and after the underline character is always -PTXdist specific. What does it mean: - -- ``*_VERSION`` brings in the version number of the release and is used - for the download and IPKG/OPKG package generation. - -- ``*_MD5`` to be sure the correct package has been downloaded, PTXdist - checks the given MD5 sum against the archive content. If both sums do - not match, PTXdist rejects the archive and fails the currently - running build. - -- ``*_SUFFIX`` defines the archive type, to make PTXdist choosing the - correct extracting tool. - -- ``*_URL`` defines the full qualified URL into the web for download. If - alternative download locations are known, they can be listed in this - variable, delimiter character is the space. - -- ``*_SOURCE`` tells PTXdist where to store the downloaded package. - -- ``*_DIR`` points to the directory this package will be built later on - by PTXdist. - -- ``*_LICENSE`` enables the user to get a list of licenses she/he is - using in her/his project (licenses of the enabled packages). - -After enabling the menu entry, we can start to check the *get* and -*extract* stages, calling them manually one after another. - -.. note:: The shown commands below expect that PTXdist downloads the - archives to a global directory named ``global_src``. This is not the - default setting, but we recommend to use a global directory to share all - archives between PTXdist based projects. Advantage is every download - happens only once. Refer to the ``setup`` command PTXdist provides. - -.. code-block:: text - - $ ptxdist get foo - - --------------------------- - target: foo-1.1.0.tar.gz - --------------------------- - - --2009-12-21 10:54:45-- http://www.foo.com/download/src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz - Length: 291190 (284K) [application/x-gzip] - Saving to: `/global_src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz.XXXXOGncZA' - - 100%[======================================>] 291,190 170K/s in 1.7s - - 2009-12-21 10:54:48 (170 KB/s) - `/global_src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz' saved [291190/291190] - -This command should start to download the source archive. If it fails, -we should check our network connection, proxy setup or if the given URL -in use is correct. - -.. note:: Sometimes we do not know the content of all the other variables in - the rule file. To get an idea what content a variable has, we can ask - PTXdist about it: - -.. code-block:: text - - $ ptxdist print FOO_URL - http://www.foo.com/download/src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz - -The next step would be to extract the archive. But as PTXdist checks the -MD5 sum in this case, this step will fail, because the ``FOO_MD5`` -variable is still empty. Let’s fill it: - -.. code-block:: text - - $ md5sum /global_src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz - 9a09840ab775a139ebb00f57a587b447 - -This string must be assigned to the FOO_MD5 in our new ``foo.make`` -rule file: - -.. code-block:: text - - FOO_MD5 := 9a09840ab775a139ebb00f57a587b447 - -We are now prepared for the next step: - -.. code-block:: text - - $ ptxdist extract foo - - ----------------------- - target: foo.extract - ----------------------- - - extract: archive=/global_src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz - extract: dest=/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target - PATCHIN: packet=foo-1.1.0 - PATCHIN: dir=/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0 - PATCHIN: no patches for foo-1.1.0 available - Fixing up /home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0/configure - finished target foo.extract - -In this example we expect an autotoolized source package. E.g. to -prepare the build, the archive comes with a ``configure`` script. This -is the default case for PTXdist. So, there is no need to modify the rule -file and we can simply run: - -.. code-block:: text - - $ ptxdist prepare foo - - ----------------------- - target: foo.prepare - ----------------------- - - [...] - - checking build system type... i686-host-linux-gnu - checking host system type... |ptxdistCompilerName| - checking whether to enable maintainer-specific portions of Makefiles... no - checking for a BSD-compatible install... /usr/bin/install -c - checking whether build environment is sane... yes - checking for a thread-safe mkdir -p... /bin/mkdir -p - checking for gawk... gawk - checking whether make sets $(MAKE)... yes - checking for |ptxdistCompilerName|-strip... |ptxdistCompilerName|-strip - checking for |ptxdistCompilerName|-gcc... |ptxdistCompilerName|-gcc - checking for C compiler default output file name... a.out - - [...] - - configure: creating ./config.status - config.status: creating Makefile - config.status: creating ppa_protocol/Makefile - config.status: creating config.h - config.status: executing depfiles commands - finished target foo.prepare - -At this stage things can fail: - -- A wrong or no MD5 sum was given - -- The ``configure`` script is not cross compile aware - -- The package depends on external components (libraries for example) - -If the ``configure`` script is not cross compile aware, we are out of -luck. We must patch the source archive in this case to make it work. -Refer to the section :ref:`configure_rebuild` on how to use -PTXdist’s features to simplify this task. -If the package depends on external components, these components might -be already part of PTXdist. In this case we just have to add this -dependency into the menu file and we are done. But if PTXdist cannot -fulfill this dependency, we also must add it as a separate package -first. - -If the *prepare* stage has finished successfully, the next step is to -compile the package. - -.. code-block:: text - - $ ptxdist compile foo - - ----------------------- - target: foo.compile - ----------------------- - - make[1]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' - make all-recursive - make[2]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' - make[3]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' - - [...] - - make[3]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' - make[2]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' - make[1]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' - finished target foo.compile - -At this stage things can fail: - -- The build system is not cross compile aware (it tries to execute just - created target binaries for example) - -- The package depends on external components (libraries for example) - not detected by ``configure`` - -- Sources are ignoring the endianness of some architectures or using - header files from the build host system (from ``/usr/include`` for - example) - -- The linker uses libraries from the build host system (from - ``/usr/lib`` for example) by accident - -In all of these cases we must patch the sources to make them work. Refer -to section :ref:`patching_packages` on how to use PTXdist’s -features to simplify this task. - -In this example we expect the best case: everything went fine, even for -cross compiling. So, we can continue with the next stage: *install* - -.. code-block:: text - - $ ptxdist install foo - - ----------------------- - target: foo.install - ----------------------- - - make[1]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' - make[2]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' - make[3]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' - test -z "/usr/bin" || /bin/mkdir -p "/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0/usr/bin" - /usr/bin/install -c 'foo' '/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0/usr/bin/foo' - make[3]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' - make[2]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' - make[1]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' - finished target foo.install - - ---------------------------- - target: foo.install.post - ---------------------------- - - finished target foo.install.post - -This *install* stage does not install anything to the target root -filesystem. It is mostly intended to install libraries and header files -other programs should link against later on. - -The last stage – *targetinstall* – is the one that defines the package’s -components to be forwarded to the target’s root filesystem. Due to the -absence of a generic way, this is the task of the developer. So, at this -point of time we must run our favourite editor again and modify our new -rule file ``./rules/foo.make``. - -The skeleton for the *targetinstall* stage looks like this: - -.. code-block:: make - - # ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- - # Target-Install - # ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- - - $(STATEDIR)/foo.targetinstall: - @$(call targetinfo) - - @$(call install_init, foo) - @$(call install_fixup, foo,PACKAGE,foo) - @$(call install_fixup, foo,PRIORITY,optional) - @$(call install_fixup, foo,VERSION,$(FOO_VERSION)) - @$(call install_fixup, foo,SECTION,base) - @$(call install_fixup, foo,AUTHOR,"My Name <me@my-org.com>") - @$(call install_fixup, foo,DEPENDS,) - @$(call install_fixup, foo,DESCRIPTION,missing) - - @$(call install_copy, foo, 0, 0, 0755, $(FOO_DIR)/foobar, /dev/null) - - @$(call install_finish, foo) - @$(call touch) - -The “header” of this stage defines some information IPKG needs. The -important part that we must modify is the call to the ``install_copy`` -macro (refer to section :ref:`reference_macros` for more details -about this kind of macros). This call instructs PTXdist to include the -given file (with UID, GID and permissions) into the IPKG, which means to -install this file to the target’s root filesystem. - -From the previous *install* stage we know this package installs an -executable called ``foo`` to location ``/usr/bin``. We can do the same -for our target by changing the *install\_copy* line to: - -.. code-block:: none - - @$(call install_copy, foo, 0, 0, 0755, $(FOO_DIR)/foo, /usr/bin/foo) - -To check it, we just run: - -.. code-block:: text - - $ ptxdist targetinstall foo - - ----------------------------- - target: foo.targetinstall - ----------------------------- - - install_init: preparing for image creation... - install_init: @ARCH@ -> i386 ... done - install_init: preinst not available - install_init: postinst not available - install_init: prerm not available - install_init: postrm not available - install_fixup: @PACKAGE@ -> foo ... done. - install_fixup: @PRIORITY@ -> optional ... done. - install_fixup: @VERSION@ -> 1.1.0 ... done. - install_fixup: @SECTION@ -> base ... done. - install_fixup: @AUTHOR@ -> "My Name <me\@my-org.com>" ... done. - install_fixup: @DESCRIPTION@ -> missing ... done. - install_copy: - src=/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0/foo - dst=/usr/bin/foo - owner=0 - group=0 - permissions=0755 - xpkg_finish: collecting license (unknown) ... done. - xpkg_finish: creating ipkg package ... done. - finished target foo.targetinstall - - ---------------------------------- - target: foo.targetinstall.post - ---------------------------------- - - finished target foo.targetinstall.post - -After this command, the target’s root filesystem contains a file called -``/usr/bin/foo`` owned by root, its group is also root and everyone has -execution permissions, but only the user root has write permissions. - -One last task of this port is still open: A reasonable location for -the new menu entry in PTXdist’s menu hierarchy. PTXdist arranges its -menus on the meaning of each package. Is it a network related tool? Or -a scripting language? Or a graphical application? -Each of these global meanings has its own submenu, where we can add -our new entry to. We just have to edit the head of our new menu file -``./rules/foo.in`` to add it to a specific global menu. If our new -package is a network related tool, the head of the menu file should -look like: - -.. code-block:: kconfig - - ## SECTION=networking - -We can grep through the other menu files from the PTXdist main -installation ``rules/`` directory to get an idea what section names are -available: - -.. code-block:: text - - rules/ $ find . -name \*.in | xargs grep "## SECTION" - ./acpid.in:## SECTION=shell_and_console - ./alsa-lib.in:## SECTION=system_libraries - ./alsa-utils.in:## SECTION=multimedia_sound - ./apache2.in:## SECTION=networking - ./apache2_mod_python.in:## SECTION=networking - [...] - ./xkeyboard-config.in:## SECTION=multimedia_xorg_data - ./xorg-app-xev.in:## SECTION=multimedia_xorg_app - ./xorg-app-xrandr.in:## SECTION=multimedia_xorg_app - ./host-eggdbus.in:## SECTION=hosttools_noprompt - ./libssh2.in:## SECTION=networking - -Porting a new package to PTXdist is (almost) finished now. - -To check it right away, we simply run these two commands: - -.. code-block:: text - - $ ptxdist clean foo - rm -rf /home/jbe/my_new_prj/state/foo.* - rm -rf /home/jbe/my_new_prj/packages/foo_* - rm -rf /home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0 - $ ptxdist targetinstall foo - - [...] - -.. important:: Discover somehow hidden dependencies with one more last check! - -Up to this point all the development of the new package was done in an already -built BSP. Doing so sometimes somehow hidden dependencies cannot be seen: -everything seems fine, the new package builds always successfully and the -results are working on the target. - -So to check for this kind of dependencies there is still one more final check -to do (even if its boring and takes time): - -.. code-block:: text - - $ ptxdist clean - [...] - $ ptxdist targetinstall foo - [...] - -This will re-start with a **clean** BSP and builds exactly the new package and -its (known) dependencies. If this builds successfully as well we are really done -with the new package. - -Some Notes about Licenses -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ - -The already mentioned rule variable ``*_LICENSE`` (e.g. ``FOO_LICENSE`` in our -example) is very important and must be filled by the developer of the package. -Many licenses bring in obligations using the corresponding package (*attribution* -for example). To make life easier for everybody the license for a package must -be provided. *SPDX* license identifiers unify the license names and are used -in PTXdist to identify license types and obligations. - -If a package comes with more than one license, all of their SPDX identifiers -must be listed and connected with the keyword ``AND``. If your package comes -with GPL-2.0 and LGPL-2.1 licenses, the definition should look like this: - -.. code-block:: make - - FOO_LICENSE := GPL-2.0 AND LGPL-2.1 - -One specific obligation cannot be detected examining the SPDX license identifiers -by PTXdist: *the license choice*. In this case all licenses of choice must be -listed and connected by the keyword ``OR``. - -If, for example, your obligation is to select one of the licenses *GPL-2.0* **or** -*GPL-3.0*, the ``*_LICENSE`` variable should look like this: - -.. code-block:: make - - FOO_LICENSE := GPL-2.0 OR GPL-3.0 - -SPDX License Identifiers -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ - -A list of SPDX license identifiers can be found here: - - https://spdx.org/licenses/ - -Help to Detect the Correct License -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ - -License identification isn't trivial. A help in doing so can be the following -repository and its content. It contains a list of known licenses based on their -SPDX identifier. The content is without formatting to simplify text search. - - https://github.com/spdx/license-list-data/tree/master/text - -Advanced Rule Files -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ - -The previous example on how to create a rule file sometimes works as -shown above. But most of the time source archives are not that simple. -In this section we want to give the user a more detailed selection how -the package will be built. - -Adding Static Configure Parameters -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ - -The ``configure`` scripts of various source archives provide additional -parameters to enable or disable features, or to configure them in a -specific way. - -We assume the ``configure`` script of our ``foo`` example (refer to -section :ref:`foo_example`) supports two additional parameters: - -- **--enable-debug**: Make the program more noisy. It’s disabled by - default. - -- **--with-bar**: Also build the special executable **bar**. Building - this executable is also disabled by default. - -We now want to forward these options to the ``configure`` script when it -runs in the *prepare* stage. To do so, we must again open the rule file -with our favourite editor and navigate to the *prepare* stage entry. - -PTXdist uses the variable ``FOO_CONF_OPT`` as the list of parameters to -be given to ``configure``. - -Currently this variable is commented out and defined to: - -.. code-block:: make - - # FOO_CONF_OPT := $(CROSS_AUTOCONF_USR) - -The variable ``CROSS_AUTOCONF_USR`` is predefined by PTXdist and -contains all basic parameters to instruct ``configure`` to prepare for a -**cross** compile environment. - -To use the two additional mentioned ``configure`` parameters, we comment -in this line and supplement this expression as follows: - -.. code-block:: make - - FOO_CONF_OPT := \ - $(CROSS_AUTOCONF_USR) \ - --enable-debug \ - --with-bar - -.. note:: We recommend to use this format with each parameter on a line of - its own. This format is easier to read and a diff shows more exactly any - change. - -To do a fast check if this addition was successful, we run: - -.. code-block:: text - - $ ptxdist print FOO_CONF_OPT - --prefix=/usr --sysconfdir=/etc --host=|ptxdistCompilerName| --build=i686-host-linux-gnu --enable-debug --with-bar - -.. note:: It depends on the currently selected platform and its architecture - what content this variable will have. The content shown above is an - example for a target. - -Or re-build the package with the new settings: - -.. code-block:: text - - $ ptxdist drop foo prepare - $ ptxdist targetinstall foo - -Adding Dynamic Configure Parameters -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ - -Sometimes it makes sense to add this kind of parameters on demand only; -especially a parameter like ``--enable-debug``. To let the user decide -if this parameter is to be used or not, we must add a menu entry. So, -let’s expand our menu. Here is its current content: - -.. code-block:: kconfig - - ## SECTION=project_specific - - config FOO - tristate - prompt "foo" - help - FIXME - -We’ll add two menu entries, one for each optional parameter we want to -add on demand to the ``configure`` parameters: - -.. code-block:: kconfig - - ## SECTION=project_specific - - config FOO - tristate - prompt "foo" - help - FIXME - - if FOO - config FOO_DEBUG - bool - prompt "add debug noise" - - config FOO_BAR - bool - prompt "build bar" - - endif - -.. important:: Always follow the rule to extend the base name by a suboption - name as the trailing part of the variable name. This gives PTXdist the ability - to detect a change in the package’s settings (via menuconfig) to force its - rebuild on demand. - -To make usage of the new menu entries, we must check them in the rule -file and add the correct parameters: - -.. code-block:: make - - # - # autoconf - # - FOO_CONF_OPT := \ - $(CROSS_AUTOCONF_USR) \ - --$(call ptx/endis, PTXCONF_FOO_DEBUG)-debug \ - --$(call ptx/wwo, PTXCONF_FOO_BAR)-bar - -.. important:: Please note the leading ``PTXCONF_`` for each define. While Kconfig is - using ``FOO_BAR``, the rule file must use ``PTXCONF_FOO_BAR`` instead. - -.. note:: Refer :ref:`Rule File Macro Reference <param_macros>` for further - details about these special kind of option macros (e.g. ``ptx/...``). - -It is a good practice to always add both settings, e.g. ``--disable-debug`` -even if this is the default case. Sometimes ``configure`` tries to guess -something and the binary result might differ depending on the build -order. For example some kind of package would also build some X related -tools, if X libraries are found. In this case it depends on the build -order, if the X related tools are built or not. All the autocheck -features are problematic here. So, if we do not want ``configure`` to -guess its settings we **must disable everything we do not want**. - -To support this process, PTXdist supplies a helper script, located at -``/path/to/ptxdist/scripts/configure-helper.py`` that compares the configure -output with the settings from ``FOO_CONF_OPT``: - -.. code-block:: text - - $ /opt/ptxdist-2017.06.0/scripts/configure-helper.py -p libsigrok - --- rules/libsigrok.make - +++ libsigrok-0.5.0 - @@ -4,3 +4,74 @@ - --libdir=/usr/lib - --build=x86_64-host-linux-gnu - --host=arm-v7a-linux-gnueabihf - + --enable-warnings=min|max|fatal|no - + --disable-largefile - + --enable-all-drivers - + --enable-agilent-dmm - [...] - + --enable-ruby - + --enable-java - + --without-libserialport - + --without-libftdi - + --without-libusb - + --without-librevisa - + --without-libgpib - + --without-libieee1284 - + --with-jni-include-path=DIR-LIST - -In this example, many configure options from libsigrok (marked with ``+``) -are not yet present in ``LIBSIGROK_CONF_OPT`` and must be added, possibly also -by providing more dynamic options in the package definition. - -If some parts of a package are built on demand only, they must also be -installed on demand only. Besides the *prepare* stage, we also must -modify our *targetinstall* stage: - -.. code-block:: make - - @$(call install_copy, foo, 0, 0, 0755, $(FOO_DIR)/foo, /usr/bin/foo) - - ifdef PTXCONF_FOO_BAR - @$(call install_copy, foo, 0, 0, 0755, $(FOO_DIR)/bar, /usr/bin/bar) - endif - - @$(call install_finish, foo) - @$(call touch) - -Now we can play with our new menu entries and check if they are working -as expected: - -.. code-block:: text - - $ ptxdist menuconfig - $ ptxdist targetinstall foo - -Whenever we change a *FOO* related menu entry, PTXdist should detect it -and re-build the package when a new build is started. - -.. _external_dependencies: - -Managing External Compile Time Dependencies -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ - -While running the prepare stage, it could happen that it fails due to a -missing external dependency. - -For example: - -.. code-block:: text - - checking whether zlib exists....failed - -In this example, our new package depends on the compression library -*zlib*. PTXdist comes with a target *zlib*. All we need to do in this -case is to declare that our new package *foo* depends on *zlib*. This -kind of dependency is managed in the menu file of our new package by -simply adding the ``select ZLIB`` line. After this addition our menu -file looks like: - -.. code-block:: kconfig - - ## SECTION=project_specific - - config FOO - tristate - select ZLIB - prompt "foo" - help - FIXME - - if FOO - config FOO_DEBUG - bool - prompt "add debug noise" - - config FOO_BAR - bool - prompt "build bar" - - endif - -PTXdist now builds the *zlib* first and our new package thereafter. - -Refer :ref:`external_dependencies_variants` for more specific dependency -description. - -Managing External Compile Time Dependencies on Demand -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ - -It is good practice to add only those dependencies that are really -required for the current configuration of the package. If the package -provides the features *foo* and *bar* and its ``configure`` provides -switches to enable/disable them independently, we can also add -dependencies on demand. Let’s assume feature *foo* needs the compression -library *libz* and *bar* needs the XML2 library *libxml2*. These -libraries are only required at run-time if the corresponding feature is -enabled. To add these dependencies on demand, the menu file looks like: - -.. code-block:: kconfig - - ## SECTION=project_specific - - config FOO - tristate - select ZLIB if FOO_FOO - select LIBXML2 if FOO_BAR - prompt "foo" - help - FIXME - - if FOO - config FOO_DEBUG - bool - prompt "add debug noise" - - config FOO_FOO - bool - prompt "build foo" - - config FOO_BAR - bool - prompt "build bar" - - endif - -.. important:: Do not add these ``select`` statements to the corresponding menu entry. - They must belong to the main menu entry of the package to ensure that - the calculation of the dependencies between the packages is done in a - correct manner. - -Managing External Runtime Dependencies -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ - -Some packages are building all of their components and also installing -them into the target’s sysroot. But only their *targetinstall* stage -decides which parts are copied to the root filesystem. So, compiling and -linking of our package will work, because everything required is found -in the target’s sysroot. - -In our example there is a hidden dependency to the math library -``libm``. Our new package was built successfully, because the linker was -able to link our binaries against the ``libm`` from the toolchain. But -in this case the ``libm`` must also be available in the target’s root -filesystem to fulfil the run-time dependency: We have to force PTXdist to -install ``libm``. ``libm`` is part of the *glibc* package, but is not -installed by default (to keep the root filesystem small). So, it **does -not** help to select the ``GLIBC`` symbol, to get a ``libm`` at run-time. - -The correct solution here is to add a ``select LIBC_M`` to our menu -file. With all the additions above it now looks like: - -.. code-block:: kconfig - - ## SECTION=project_specific - - config FOO - tristate - select ZLIB if FOO_FOO - select LIBXML2 if FOO_BAR - select LIBC_M - prompt "foo" - help - FIXME - - if FOO - config FOO_DEBUG - bool - prompt "add debug noise" - - config FOO_FOO - bool - prompt "build foo" - - config FOO_BAR - bool - prompt "build bar" - - endif - -.. note:: There are other packages around, that do not install everything by - default. If our new package needs something special, we must take a look - into the menu of the other package how to force the required components - to be installed and add the corresponding ``selects`` to our own menu - file. In this case it does not help to enable the required parts in our - project configuration, because this has no effect on the build order! - -Managing Plain Makefile Packages -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ - -Many packages are still coming with a plain ``Makefile``. The user has -to adapt it to make it work in a cross compile environment as well. -PTXdist can also handle this kind of packages. We only have to specify -a special *prepare* and *compile* stage. - -Such packages often have no special need for any kind of preparation. In -this we must instruct PTXdist to do nothing in the *prepare* stage: - -.. code-block:: make - - FOO_CONF_TOOL := NO - -To compile the package, we can use ``make``\ ’s feature to overwrite -variables used in the ``Makefile``. With this feature we can still use -the original ``Makefile`` but with our own (cross compile) settings. - -Most of the time the generic compile rule can be used, only a few -settings are required. For a well defined ``Makefile`` it is sufficient to -set up the correct cross compile environment for the *compile* stage: - -.. code-block:: make - - FOO_MAKE_ENV := $(CROSS_ENV) - -``make`` will be called in this case with: - -``$(FOO_MAKE_ENV) $(MAKE) -C $(FOO_DIR) $(FOO_MAKE_OPT)`` - -So, in the rule file only the two variables ``FOO_MAKE_ENV`` and -``FOO_MAKE_OPT`` must be set, to forward the required settings to the -package’s buildsystem. If the package cannot be built in parallel, we -can also add the ``FOO_MAKE_PAR := NO``. ``YES`` is the default. - -Managing CMake/QMake/Meson Packages -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ - -Building packages that use ``cmake``, ``qmake`` or ``meson`` is much like -building packages with an autotools based buildsystem. We need to specify -the configuration tool: - -.. code-block:: make - - FOO_CONF_TOOL := cmake - -or - -.. code-block:: make - - FOO_CONF_TOOL := qmake - -or respectively - -.. code-block:: make - - FOO_CONF_TOOL := meson - -And provide the correct configuration options. The syntax is different so -PTXdist provides additional macros to simplify configurable features. -For ``cmake`` the configuration options typically look like this: - -.. code-block:: make - - FOO_CONF_OPT := \ - $(CROSS_CMAKE_USR) \ - -DBUILD_TESTS:BOOL=OFF \ - -DENABLE_BAR:BOOL=$(call ptx/onoff, PTXCONF_FOO_BAR) - -For ``qmake`` the configuration options typically look like this: - -.. code-block:: make - - FOO_CONF_OPT := \ - $(CROSS_QMAKE_OPT) \ - PREFIX=/usr - -And for ``meson`` the configuration options typically look like this: - -.. code-block:: make - - FOO_CONF_OPT := \ - $(CROSS_MESON_USR) \ - -Dbar=$(call ptx/truefalse,PTXCONF_FOO_BAR) - -Please note that currently only host and target ``cmake``\/``meson`` packages -and only target ``qmake`` packages are supported. - -Managing Python Packages -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ - -As with any other package, the correct configuration tool must be selected -for Python packages: - -.. code-block:: make - - FOO_CONF_TOOL := python - -.. note:: For Python3 packages the value must be ``python3``. - -No Makefiles are used when building Python packages so the usual ``make`` -and ``make install`` for the *compile* and *install* stages cannot be used. -PTXdist will call ``python setup.py build`` and ``python setup.py install`` -instead. - -.. note:: *FOO* is still the name of our example package. It must be - replaced by the real package name. - - -.. _patching_packages: - -Patching Packages -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ - -There can be various reasons why a package must be patched: - -- Package is broken for cross compile environments - -- Package is broken within a specific feature - -- Package is vulnerable and needs some fixes - -- or anything else (this case is the most common one) - -Ideally, those problems should be addressed in the original project, -so any patches you add to your BSP or to PTXdist should also be submitted upstream. -The upstream project can often provide better feedback, they can integrate your -patch into a new release, and also maintain your changes as part of the project. -This way we make sure that all advantages of the open source idea work for us; -and your patch can be removed again later when a new release of the project is -integrated into your BSP or into PTXdist. - -PTXdist handles patching automatically. -After extracting the archive of a package, PTXdist checks for the existence of -a patch directory named like its ``<PKG>_PATCHES`` variable, or, if this variable -is not set, like its ``<PKG>`` variable. -The patch directory is then searched in all locations listed by the -``PTXDIST_PATH_PATCHES`` variable, and the first one found is used. -Take an exemplary package ``foo`` with version ``1.1.0``: -The variable ``FOO`` will have the value ``foo-1.1.0``, so PTXdist will look for -a patch directory named ``foo-1.1.0`` in the following locations: - -#. the current layer: - - a. project (``./patches/foo-1.1.0``) - b. platform (``./configs/|ptxdistPlatformConfigDir|/patches/foo-1.1.0``) - -#. any :ref:`base layers <layers-in-ptxdist>`, - applying the same search order as above for each layer recursively - -#. ptxdist (``<ptxdist/installation/path>/patches/foo-1.1.0``) - -The patches from the first location found are used. Note: Due to this -search order, a PTXdist project can replace global patches from the -PTXdist installation. This can be useful if a project sticks to a -specific PTXdist revision but fixes from a more recent revision of -PTXdist should be used. - -PTXdist uses the utilities *git*, *patch* or *quilt* to work with -patches or patch series. We recommend *git*, as it can manage patch -series in a very easy way. - -Creating a Patch Series for a Package -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ - -To create a patch series for the first time, we can run the following -steps. We are still using our *foo-1.1.0* example package here: - -Using Quilt -""""""""""" - -We create a special directory for the patch series in the local project -directory: - -.. code-block:: text - - $ mkdir -p patches/foo-1.1.0 - -PTXdist expects a ``series`` file in the patch directory and at least -one patch. Otherwise it fails. Due to the fact that we do not have any -patch content yet, we’ll start with a dummy entry in the ``series`` file -and an empty ``patch`` file. - -.. code-block:: text - - $ touch patches/foo-1.1.0/dummy - $ echo dummy > patches/foo-1.1.0/series - -Next is to extract the package (if already done, we must remove it -first): - -.. code-block:: text - - $ ptxdist extract foo - -This will extract the archive and create a symbolic link in the build -directory pointing to our local patch directory. Working this way will -ensure that we do not lose our created patches if we enter -``ptxdist clean foo`` by accident. In our case the patches are still -present in ``patches/foo-1.1.0`` and can be used the next time we -extract the package again. - -All we have to do now is to do the modification we need to make the -package work. We change into the build directory and use quilt_ to -create new patches, add files to respective patches, modify these files -and refresh the patches to save our changes. -See the *quilt* documentation (``man 1 quilt``) for more information. - -.. note:: For patches that are intended for PTXdist upstream use the git - workflow described below to get proper patch headers. - -.. _quilt: http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/quilt - -Using Git -""""""""" - -Create the patch directory like above for *quilt*, -but only add an empty series file: - -.. code-block:: text - - $ mkdir -p patches/foo-1.1.0 - $ touch patches/foo-1.1.0/series - -Then extract the package with an additional command line switch: - -.. code-block:: text - - $ ptxdist --git extract foo - -The empty series file makes PTXdist create a Git repository in the -respective package build directory, -and import the package source as the first commit. - -.. note:: Optionally, you can enable the setting *Developer Options → - use git to apply patches* in `ptxdist setup` to get this behaviour - as a default for every package. - However, note that this setting is meant for development only, and can lead - to failures – some packages try to determine if they are being compiled from - a Git source tree, and behave differently in that case. - -Then you can change into the package build directory -(``platform-<name>/build-target/foo-1.1.0``), -patch the required source files, -and make Git commits on the way. -The Git history should now look something like this: - -.. code-block:: text - - $ git log --oneline --decorate - * df343e821851 (HEAD -> master) Makefile: don't build the tests - * 65a360c2bd60 strfry.c: frobnicate the excusator - * fdc315f6844c (tag: foobar-1.1.0, tag: base) initial commit - -Finally, call ``git ptx-patches`` to transform those Git commits into the patch -series in the ``patches/foo-1.1.0`` folder. -This way they don't get lost when cleaning the package. - -.. note:: PTXdist will only create a Git repository for packages with - patches. To use Git to generate the first patch, create an empty series - file ``patches/foobar-1.1.0/series`` before extracting the packages. This - will tell PTXdist to use Git anyways and ``git ptx-patches`` will put the - patches there. - -Both approaches (Git and quilt) are not suitable for modifying files -that are autogenerated in autotools-based buildsystems. -Refer to the section :ref:`configure_rebuild` on how PTXdist can -handle this special task. - -Adding More Patches to a Package -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ - -If we want to add more patches to an already patched package, we can use -nearly the same way as creating patches for the first time. But if the -patch series comes from the PTXdist main installation, we do not have -write permissions to these directories (do NEVER work on the main -installation directories, NEVER, NEVER, NEVER). Due to the search order -in which PTXdist searches for patches for a specific package, we can -copy the global patch series to our local project directory. Now we have -the permissions to add more patches or modify the existing ones. Also -*quilt* and *git* are our friends here to manage the patch series. - -If we think that our new patches are valuable also for others, or they -fix an error, it could be a good idea to send these patches to PTXdist -mainline, and to the upstream project too. - - -.. _configure_rebuild: - -Modifying Autotoolized Packages -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ - -Autotoolized packages are very picky when automatically generated files -get patched. The patch order is very important in this case and -sometimes it even fails and nobody knows why. - -To improve a package’s autotools-based build system, PTXdist comes with -its own project local autotools to regenerate the autotools template -files, instead of patching them. With this feature, only the template -files must be patched, the required ``configure`` script and the -``Makefile.in`` files are regenerated in the final stages of the -*prepare* step. - -This feature works like the regular patching mechanism. The only -difference is the additional ``autogen.sh`` file in the patch directory. -If it exists and has execution permissions, it will be called after the -package was patched (while the *extract* stage is running). - -Its content depends on developer needs; for the most simple case the -content can be: - -.. code-block:: bash - - #!/bin/bash - - aclocal $ACLOCAL_FLAGS - - libtoolize \ - --force \ - --copy - - autoreconf \ - --force \ - --install \ - --warnings=cross \ - --warnings=syntax \ - --warnings=obsolete \ - --warnings=unsupported - -.. note:: In this way not yet autotoolized package can be autotoolized. We - just have to add the common autotool template files (``configure.ac`` - and ``Makefile.am`` for example) via a patch series to the package - source and the ``autogen.sh`` to the patch directory. - -.. _adding_files: - -Adding Binary Only Files ------------------------- - -Sometimes a few binary files have to be added into the root filesystem. -Or - to be more precise - some files, that do not need to be built in -any way. - -On the other hand, sometimes files should be included that are not -covered by any open source license and so, should not be shipped in the -source code format. - -Add Binary Files File by File -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ - -Doing to on a file by file base can happen by just using the ``install_copy`` -macro in the *targetinstall* stage in our own customized rules file. - -.. code-block:: none - - @$(call install_copy, binary_example, 0, 0, 0644, \ - </path/to/some/file/>ptx_logo.png, \ - /example/ptx_logo.png) - -It copies the file ``ptx_logo.png`` from some location to target’s root -filesystem. Refer :ref:`install_copy` for further information about using the -``install_copy`` macro. - -The disadvantage of this method is: if we want to install more than one -file, we need one call to the ``install_copy`` macro per file. This is -even harder if not only a set of files is to be installed, but a whole -directory tree with files instead. - -Add Binary Files via an Archive -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ - -If a whole tree of files is to be installed, working with a *tar* based -archive could make life easier. In this case the archive itself provides -all the required information the files are needing to be installed in a -correct manner: - -- the file itself and its name - -- the directory structure and the final location of every file in this - structure - -- user and group ID on a per file base - -.. code-block:: none - - @$(call install_archive, binary_example, -, -, \ - </path/to/an/>archive.tgz, /) - -Refer :ref:`install_archive` for further information about using the -``install_archive`` macro. - -Using an archive can be useful to install parts of the root filesystem -that are not covered by any open source license. Its possible to ship -the binaries within the regular BSP, without the need for their sources. -However it is possible for the customer to re-create everything required -from the BSP to get their target up and running again. - -Another use case for the archive method could be the support for -different development teams. One team provides a software component in -the archive format, the other team does not need to build it but can use -it in the same way than every other software component. - -Creating a Rules File -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ - -Let PTXdist create one for us. - -.. code-block:: text - - $ ptxdist newpackage file - - ptxdist: creating a new 'file' package: - - ptxdist: enter package name.......: my_binfiles - ptxdist: enter version number.....: 1 - ptxdist: enter package author.....: My Name <me@my-org.com> - ptxdist: enter package section....: rootfs - -Now two new files are present in the BSP: - -#. ``rules/my_binfiles.in`` The template for the menu - -#. ``rules/my_binfiles.make`` The rules template - -Both files now must be customized to meet our requirements. Due to the -answer *rootfs* to the “``enter package section``” question, we will -find the new menu entry in: - -.. code-block:: text - - Root Filesystem ---> - < > my_binfiles (NEW) - -Enabling this new entry will also run our stages in -``rules/my_binfiles.make`` the next time we enter: - -.. code-block:: text - - $ ptxdist go - -Creating New Package Templates ------------------------------- - -For larger projects it can be convenient to have project specific package -templates. This can be achieved by either modifying existing templates or -by creating completely new templates. - -Modifying a Template -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ - -A template can be modified by providing new input files. This is easier -than creating a new template but does not allow to specify new variables to -substitute in the input files. - -PTXdist looks for template files the same way it looks for rules files. The -only difference is, that it searches in the ``templates/`` subdirectory. -So a modified ``./rules/templates/template-target-make`` can be used to -tweak the ``target`` template. - -Creating a New Template -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ - -For a completely new template, some bash scripting is required. All shell -code must be placed in a file named like this: -``./scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_*.sh``. - -The minimum requirement for a new template is: -- a shell function that creates the new package -- registering the new template - -.. code-block:: sh - - ptxd_template_new_mypkg() { - # create the package here - } - export -f ptxd_template_new_mypkg - ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="mypkg" - ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="create awesome mypkg package" - -PTXdist provides several helper functions to simplify the template. -Using those functions, the package creation process is split into two -parts: - -- query the user for input and export variables. -- create the new package files from the template source files by - substituting all instances of ``@<variable>@`` with the value of the - corresponding variable. - -A simple template function could look like this: - -.. code-block:: sh - - ptxd_template_new_mypkg() { - ptxd_template_read_basic && - ptxd_template_read "enter download section" DL_SECTION "foobar" - ptxd_template_read_author && - export section="local_${dlsection}" && - ptxd_template_write_rules - } - -This template requires ``rules/templates/template-mypkg-make`` and -``rules/templates/template-mypkg-in`` as source files. They could be -derived from the ``target`` template with a simple modification: - -.. code-block:: make - - @PACKAGE@_SUFFIX := tar.xz - @PACKAGE@_URL := http://dl.my-company.local/downloads/@DL_SECTION@/$(@PACKAGE@).$(@PACKAGE@_SUFFIX) - -The helper functions that are used in the example above are defined in -``scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh`` in the PTXdist source tree. - -The template is a normal shell function. Arbitrary things can be done here -to create the new package. The helper functions are just the most -convenient way to crate simple templates. It is also possible to create -more files. For examples, the builtin ``genimage`` template creates a extra -config file for the new package. - -.. _layers-in-ptxdist: - -Layers in PTXdist ------------------ - -For better maintenance or other reasons, a PTXdist project can be split -into multiple layers. Each layer has exactly the same directory hierarchy -as described in :ref:`directory_hierarchy` and other chapters. - -All layers are explicitly stacked in the filesystem. The top layer is the -workspace of the PTXdist project. Any ``selected_*`` links and the platform -build directory are created here. The layer below is defined by the -subdirectory or symlink named ``base/``. More can be stacked the same -way, so ``base/base/`` is the third layer and so on. -In many ways, PTXdist itself can be considered as the bottom layer. This is -either implicit or explicit with one last ``base/`` symlink. - -A project can overwrite files provided by PTXdist in many different ways, -e.g. rule files or files installed with :ref:`install_alternative` etc. -This concept expands naturally to layers. Each layer can overwrite files -provided by lower layers in the exact same way. Any files are always -searched for in a strict layer by layer order. - -Writing Layer Aware Rules -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ - -For the most part, package rules work just as expected when multiple layers -are used. Any layer specific handling is done implicitly by PTXdist. -However, there are a few things that need special handling. - -The variables :ref:`PTXDIST_WORKSPACE<ptxdist_workspace>` and -:ref:`PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR`<ptxdist_platformconfigdir>` always refer -to the directories in the top layer. These variables might be used in rules -files like this: - -.. code-block:: make - - MY_KERNEL_CONFIG := $(PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR)/kernelconfig.special - -If the referenced file is in any layer but the top one then it will not -be found. To handle use-cases like this, the macros :ref:`in_path` and -:ref:`in_platformconfigdir` can be used: - -.. code-block:: make - - MY_KERNEL_CONFIG := $(call ptx/in-platformconfigdir, kernelconfig.special) - -This way, the layers are searched top to bottom until the config file is -found. - -PTXdist Config Files with Multiple Layers -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ - -In many cases a layer may want to modify the **ptxconfig** by enabling or -disabling some options. Any changes must be propagated through the whole -layer stack. - -The features and workflow described here apply to the **ptxconfig**, the -**platformconfig** and any **collectionconfig** used in the project. - -To do this, PTXdist stores a delta config to the layer below and a full -config file in each layer. If the two files are missing then the config is -unchanged. The bottom layer has only the config file and no delta. - -At runtime, PTXdist will always use the full config file in the top layer -where the config exists. Before doing so, it will ensure that the config is -consistent across all layers. This means that, for any layer that contains a -delta config, the full config file of the layer below has not changed since -the delta config was last updated. If any inconsistency is detected, -PTXdist will abort. - -For any command that modifies the config file, except ``oldconfig``, -PTXdist will use kconfig implicitly on all layers to check if the config -for this layer is up to date. This is a stricter check than the consistency -validation. For example, if a new package was added to a layer without -updating the **ptxconfig** then this will be detected and PTXdist will -abort. If all other layers are up to date, then PTXdist will use the delta -config of the top layer, apply it to the full config of the layer below -and execute the specified command with the resulting config file. - -.. note:: If the config file does not exist yet on the top layer, then it - will be created if changes to the config are made. Similarly the config - will be deleted if the delta is empty after the changes. In either case - it may be necessary to update any ``selected_*`` link to point to the - correct config. - -If PTXdist detects an inconsistency or an out of date config file then it -must be updated before they can be used. This can be done by using the -``oldconfig`` command. In this special case, PTXdist will iterate from the -bottom to the top layer and run ``oldconfig`` for each of them. It will -use the delta config applied to the full config of the layer below at each -step. This means that it's possible to enable or disable a option in the -bottom layer and ``oldconfig`` will propagate this change to all other -layers. - -Packages with kconfig Based Config Files -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ - -For packages such as the Linux kernel that have kconfig based config files, -a lot of the infrastructure to handle config files and deltas across -multiple layers can be reused. Consistency validation is done implicitly -and ``menuconfig`` and other kconfig commands will use config files and -deltas as expected. - -It's not possible to implicitly run ``oldconfig`` on other layers (this may -require a different source tree for the packages), so any inconsistencies -must be resolved manually by running ``oldconfig`` explicitly on each -layer. - -The make macros that provide these features are currently used by the -barebox and kernel packages and templates. +.. toctree:: + :glob: + :maxdepth: 2 + + dev_dir_hierarchy + dev_add_new_pkgs + dev_add_bin_only_files + dev_create_new_pkg_templates + dev_layers_in_ptxdist -- 2.27.0 _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* Re: [ptxdist] [APPLIED] doc: dev_manual: split up into multiple files 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 3/6] doc: dev_manual: split up into multiple files Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-19 22:04 ` Michael Olbrich 0 siblings, 0 replies; 24+ messages in thread From: Michael Olbrich @ 2020-06-19 22:04 UTC (permalink / raw) To: ptxdist; +Cc: Bastian Krause Thanks, applied as 5d42f6f4ef8142b15629064cc826a2b7298b4995. Michael [sent from post-receive hook] On Sat, 20 Jun 2020 00:04:07 +0200, Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> wrote: > Split the lengthy developer's manual into multiple files to ease > navigation when editing. > > No further change to the content. > > Signed-off-by: Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> > Reviewed-by: Roland Hieber <rhi@pengutronix.de> > Tested-by: Ladislav Michl <ladis@linux-mips.org> > Message-Id: <20200617143125.23999-4-bst@pengutronix.de> > Signed-off-by: Michael Olbrich <m.olbrich@pengutronix.de> > > diff --git a/doc/dev_add_bin_only_files.rst b/doc/dev_add_bin_only_files.rst > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000000..9031e437cd4f > --- /dev/null > +++ b/doc/dev_add_bin_only_files.rst > @@ -0,0 +1,105 @@ > +.. _adding_files: > + > +Adding Binary Only Files > +------------------------ > + > +Sometimes a few binary files have to be added into the root filesystem. > +Or - to be more precise - some files, that do not need to be built in > +any way. > + > +On the other hand, sometimes files should be included that are not > +covered by any open source license and so, should not be shipped in the > +source code format. > + > +Add Binary Files File by File > +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > + > +Doing to on a file by file base can happen by just using the ``install_copy`` > +macro in the *targetinstall* stage in our own customized rules file. > + > +.. code-block:: none > + > + @$(call install_copy, binary_example, 0, 0, 0644, \ > + </path/to/some/file/>ptx_logo.png, \ > + /example/ptx_logo.png) > + > +It copies the file ``ptx_logo.png`` from some location to target’s root > +filesystem. Refer :ref:`install_copy` for further information about using the > +``install_copy`` macro. > + > +The disadvantage of this method is: if we want to install more than one > +file, we need one call to the ``install_copy`` macro per file. This is > +even harder if not only a set of files is to be installed, but a whole > +directory tree with files instead. > + > +Add Binary Files via an Archive > +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > + > +If a whole tree of files is to be installed, working with a *tar* based > +archive could make life easier. In this case the archive itself provides > +all the required information the files are needing to be installed in a > +correct manner: > + > +- the file itself and its name > + > +- the directory structure and the final location of every file in this > + structure > + > +- user and group ID on a per file base > + > +.. code-block:: none > + > + @$(call install_archive, binary_example, -, -, \ > + </path/to/an/>archive.tgz, /) > + > +Refer :ref:`install_archive` for further information about using the > +``install_archive`` macro. > + > +Using an archive can be useful to install parts of the root filesystem > +that are not covered by any open source license. Its possible to ship > +the binaries within the regular BSP, without the need for their sources. > +However it is possible for the customer to re-create everything required > +from the BSP to get their target up and running again. > + > +Another use case for the archive method could be the support for > +different development teams. One team provides a software component in > +the archive format, the other team does not need to build it but can use > +it in the same way than every other software component. > + > +Creating a Rules File > +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > + > +Let PTXdist create one for us. > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ ptxdist newpackage file > + > + ptxdist: creating a new 'file' package: > + > + ptxdist: enter package name.......: my_binfiles > + ptxdist: enter version number.....: 1 > + ptxdist: enter package author.....: My Name <me@my-org.com> > + ptxdist: enter package section....: rootfs > + > +Now two new files are present in the BSP: > + > +#. ``rules/my_binfiles.in`` The template for the menu > + > +#. ``rules/my_binfiles.make`` The rules template > + > +Both files now must be customized to meet our requirements. Due to the > +answer *rootfs* to the “``enter package section``” question, we will > +find the new menu entry in: > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + Root Filesystem ---> > + < > my_binfiles (NEW) > + > +Enabling this new entry will also run our stages in > +``rules/my_binfiles.make`` the next time we enter: > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ ptxdist go > diff --git a/doc/dev_add_new_pkgs.rst b/doc/dev_add_new_pkgs.rst > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000000..4ae2765c2ce9 > --- /dev/null > +++ b/doc/dev_add_new_pkgs.rst > @@ -0,0 +1,1339 @@ > +.. _adding_new_packages: > + > +Adding New Packages > +------------------- > + > +PTXdist provides a huge amount of applications sufficient for the most > +embedded use cases. But there is still need for some fancy new packages. > +This section describes the steps and the background on how to integrate > +new packages into the project. > + > +At first a summary about possible application types which PTXdist can > +handle: > + > +- **host type**: This kind of package is built to run on the build > + host. Most of the time such a package is needed if another > + target-relevant package needs to generate some data. For example the > + *glib* package depends on its own to create some data. But if it is > + compiled for the target, it can’t do so. That’s why a host glib > + package is required to provide these utilities runnable on the build > + host. It sounds strange to build a host package, even if on the build > + host such utilities are already installed. But this way ensures that > + there are no dependencies regarding the build host system. > + > +- **target type**: This kind of package is built for the target. > + > +- **cross type**: This kind of package is built for the build host, but > + creates architecture specific data for the target. > + > +- **src-autoconf-prog**: This kind of package is built for the target. > + It is intended for development, as it does not handle a released > + archive but a plain source project instead. Creating such a package > + will also create a small autotools based source template project on > + demand to give the developer an easy point to start. This template is > + prepared to build a single executable program. For further details refer > + section :ref:`adding_src_autoconf_exec`. > + > +- **src-autoconf-lib**: This kind of package is built for the target. > + It is intended for development, as it does not handle a released > + archive but a plain source project instead. Creating such a package > + will also create a small autotools/libtool based source template > + project on demand to give the developer an easy point to start. This > + template is prepared to build a single shared library. For further > + details refer section :ref:`adding_src_autoconf_lib`. > + > +- **src-autoconf-proglib**: This kind of package is built for the > + target. It is intended for development, as it does not handle a > + released archive but a plain source project instead. Creating such a > + package will also create a small autotools/libtool based template > + project on demand to give the developer an easy point to start. This > + template is prepared to build a single shared library and a single > + executable program. The program will be linked against the shared > + library. For further details refer section :ref:`adding_src_autoconf_exec_lib`. > + > +- **file**: This kind of package is intended to add a few simple files > + into the build process. We assume these files do not need any > + processing, they are ready to use and must only be present in the > + build process or at run-time (HTML files for example). Refer to the > + section :ref:`adding_files` for further details on how to use > + it. > + > +- **src-make-prog**: This kind of package is built for the target. It’s > + intended for development, as it does not handle a released archive > + but a plain source project instead. Creating such a package will also > + create a simple makefile-based template project the developer can use > + as a starting point for development. > + > +- **src-cmake-prog**: This kind of package is built for the target. > + It’s intended for developments based on the *cmake* buildsystem. > + Various projects are using *cmake* instead of *make* and can be built > + with this package type. PTXdist will prepare it to compile sources in > + accordance to the target libraries and their settings. Creating such > + a package will also create a simple template project to be used as a > + starting point for development. > + > +- **src-qmake-prog**: This kind of package is built for the target. > + It’s intended for developments based on the *qmake* buildsystem. If > + the developer is going to develop a QT based application, this rule > + is prepared to compile sources in accordance to the target libraries > + and their settings. Creating such a package will also create a simple > + template project to be used as a starting point for development. > + > +- **src-meson-prog**: This kind of package is built for the target. > + It’s intended for developments based on the *meson* buildsystem. > + Various projects are using *meson* today and can be built > + with this package type. PTXdist will prepare it to compile sources in > + accordance to the target libraries and their settings. Creating such > + a package will also create a simple template project to be used as a > + starting point for development. > + > +- **font**: This package is a helper to add X font files to the root > + filesystem. This package does not create an additional IPKG, instead > + it adds the font to the existing font IPKG. This includes the > + generation of the directory index files, required by the Xorg > + framework to recognize the font file. > + > +- **src-linux-driver**: This kind of package builds an out of tree > + kernel driver. It also creates a driver template to give the > + developer an easy point to start. > + > +- **kernel**: PTXdist comes with the ability to handle one kernel in its > + platform. This type of package enables us to handle more than one kernel in > + the project. > + > +- **barebox**: PTXdist comes with the ability to handle one bootloader in its > + platform. This type of package enables us to handle more than one bootloader > + in the project. > + > +- **image-tgz**: This kind of package creates a tar ball from a list of > + packages. It is often uses as an input for other image packages. > + > +- **image-genimage**: This kind of package can handle all kind of image > + generation for almost every target independent of its complexity. > + > +- **blspec-entry**: PTXdist comes with the ability to handle one bootspec in its > + platform. This type of package enables us to handle more than one bootspec > + in the project. > + > +.. _foo_example: > + > +Rule File Creation > +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > + > +To create such a new package, we create a project local ``rules/`` > +directory first. Then we run > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ ptxdist newpackage <package type> > + > +If we omit the <``package type``\ >, PTXdist will list all available > +package types. > + > +In our first example, we want to add a new target type archive package. > +When running the > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ ptxdist newpackage target > + > +command, PTXdist asks a few questions about this package. This > +information is the basic data PTXdist must know about the package. > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + ptxdist: creating a new 'target' package: > + > + ptxdist: enter package name.......: foo > + ptxdist: enter version number.....: 1.1.0 > + ptxdist: enter URL of basedir.....: http://www.foo.com/download/src > + ptxdist: enter suffix.............: tar.gz > + ptxdist: enter package author.....: My Name <me@my-org.com> > + ptxdist: enter package section....: project_specific > + > +What we have to answer: > + > +- **package name**: As this kind of package handles a source archive, > + the correct answer here is the basename of the archive’s file name. > + If its full name is ``foo-1.1.0.tar.gz``, then ``foo`` is the > + basename to enter here. > + > +- **version number**: Most source archives are using a release or > + version number in their file name. If its full name is > + ``foo-1.1.0.tar.gz``, then ``1.1.0`` is the version number to enter > + here. > + > +- **URL of basedir**: This URL tells PTXdist where to download the > + source archive from the web (if not already done). If the full URL to > + download the archive is > + ``http://www.foo.com/download/src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz``, the basedir > + part ``http://www.foo.com/download/src`` is to be entered here. > + > +- **suffix**: Archives are using various formats for distribution. > + PTXdist uses the *suffix* entry to select the matching extraction > + tool. If the archive’s full name is ``foo-1.1.0.tar.gz``, then > + ``tar.gz`` is the suffix to enter here. > + > +- **package author**: If we intend to contribute this new package to > + PTXdist mainline, we should add our name here. This name will be used > + in the copyright note of the rule file and will also be added to the > + generated ipkg. When you run ``ptxdist setup`` prior to this call, > + you can enter your name and your email address, so PTXdist will use > + it as the default (very handy if you intend to add many new > + packages). > + > +- **package section**: We can enter here the menu section name where > + our new package menu entry should be listed. In the first step we can > + leave the default name unchanged. It’s a string in the menu file > + only, so changing it later on is still possible. > + > +Make it Work > +~~~~~~~~~~~~ > + > +Generating the rule file is only one of the required steps to get a new > +package. The next steps to make it work are to check if all stages are > +working as expected and to select the required parts to get them > +installed in the target root filesystem. Also we must find a reasonable > +location where to add our new menu entry to configure the package. > + > +The generated skeleton starts to add the new menu entry in the main > +configure menu (if we left the section name unchanged). Running > +``ptxdist menuconfig`` will show it on top of all other menus entries. > + > +.. important:: > + To be able to implement and test all the other required steps for adding > + a new package, we first must enable the package for building. (Fine > + tuning the menu can happen later on.) > + > + > +The rule file skeleton still lacks some important information. Let’s > +take a look into some of the top lines of the generated rule file > +``./rules/foo.make``: > + > +.. code-block:: make > + > + FOO_VERSION := 1.1.0 > + FOO_MD5 := > + FOO := foo-$(FOO_VERSION) > + FOO_SUFFIX := tar.gz > + FOO_URL := http://www.foo.com/download/src/$(FOO).$(FOO_SUFFIX) > + FOO_SOURCE := $(SRCDIR)/$(FOO).$(FOO_SUFFIX) > + FOO_DIR := $(BUILDDIR)/$(FOO) > + FOO_LICENSE := unknown > + > +We can find these lines with different content in most or all of the > +other rule files PTXdist comes with. Up to the underline character is > +always the package name and after the underline character is always > +PTXdist specific. What does it mean: > + > +- ``*_VERSION`` brings in the version number of the release and is used > + for the download and IPKG/OPKG package generation. > + > +- ``*_MD5`` to be sure the correct package has been downloaded, PTXdist > + checks the given MD5 sum against the archive content. If both sums do > + not match, PTXdist rejects the archive and fails the currently > + running build. > + > +- ``*_SUFFIX`` defines the archive type, to make PTXdist choosing the > + correct extracting tool. > + > +- ``*_URL`` defines the full qualified URL into the web for download. If > + alternative download locations are known, they can be listed in this > + variable, delimiter character is the space. > + > +- ``*_SOURCE`` tells PTXdist where to store the downloaded package. > + > +- ``*_DIR`` points to the directory this package will be built later on > + by PTXdist. > + > +- ``*_LICENSE`` enables the user to get a list of licenses she/he is > + using in her/his project (licenses of the enabled packages). > + > +After enabling the menu entry, we can start to check the *get* and > +*extract* stages, calling them manually one after another. > + > +.. note:: The shown commands below expect that PTXdist downloads the > + archives to a global directory named ``global_src``. This is not the > + default setting, but we recommend to use a global directory to share all > + archives between PTXdist based projects. Advantage is every download > + happens only once. Refer to the ``setup`` command PTXdist provides. > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ ptxdist get foo > + > + --------------------------- > + target: foo-1.1.0.tar.gz > + --------------------------- > + > + --2009-12-21 10:54:45-- http://www.foo.com/download/src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz > + Length: 291190 (284K) [application/x-gzip] > + Saving to: `/global_src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz.XXXXOGncZA' > + > + 100%[======================================>] 291,190 170K/s in 1.7s > + > + 2009-12-21 10:54:48 (170 KB/s) - `/global_src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz' saved [291190/291190] > + > +This command should start to download the source archive. If it fails, > +we should check our network connection, proxy setup or if the given URL > +in use is correct. > + > +.. note:: Sometimes we do not know the content of all the other variables in > + the rule file. To get an idea what content a variable has, we can ask > + PTXdist about it: > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ ptxdist print FOO_URL > + http://www.foo.com/download/src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz > + > +The next step would be to extract the archive. But as PTXdist checks the > +MD5 sum in this case, this step will fail, because the ``FOO_MD5`` > +variable is still empty. Let’s fill it: > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ md5sum /global_src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz > + 9a09840ab775a139ebb00f57a587b447 > + > +This string must be assigned to the FOO_MD5 in our new ``foo.make`` > +rule file: > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + FOO_MD5 := 9a09840ab775a139ebb00f57a587b447 > + > +We are now prepared for the next step: > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ ptxdist extract foo > + > + ----------------------- > + target: foo.extract > + ----------------------- > + > + extract: archive=/global_src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz > + extract: dest=/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target > + PATCHIN: packet=foo-1.1.0 > + PATCHIN: dir=/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0 > + PATCHIN: no patches for foo-1.1.0 available > + Fixing up /home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0/configure > + finished target foo.extract > + > +In this example we expect an autotoolized source package. E.g. to > +prepare the build, the archive comes with a ``configure`` script. This > +is the default case for PTXdist. So, there is no need to modify the rule > +file and we can simply run: > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ ptxdist prepare foo > + > + ----------------------- > + target: foo.prepare > + ----------------------- > + > + [...] > + > + checking build system type... i686-host-linux-gnu > + checking host system type... |ptxdistCompilerName| > + checking whether to enable maintainer-specific portions of Makefiles... no > + checking for a BSD-compatible install... /usr/bin/install -c > + checking whether build environment is sane... yes > + checking for a thread-safe mkdir -p... /bin/mkdir -p > + checking for gawk... gawk > + checking whether make sets $(MAKE)... yes > + checking for |ptxdistCompilerName|-strip... |ptxdistCompilerName|-strip > + checking for |ptxdistCompilerName|-gcc... |ptxdistCompilerName|-gcc > + checking for C compiler default output file name... a.out > + > + [...] > + > + configure: creating ./config.status > + config.status: creating Makefile > + config.status: creating ppa_protocol/Makefile > + config.status: creating config.h > + config.status: executing depfiles commands > + finished target foo.prepare > + > +At this stage things can fail: > + > +- A wrong or no MD5 sum was given > + > +- The ``configure`` script is not cross compile aware > + > +- The package depends on external components (libraries for example) > + > +If the ``configure`` script is not cross compile aware, we are out of > +luck. We must patch the source archive in this case to make it work. > +Refer to the section :ref:`configure_rebuild` on how to use > +PTXdist’s features to simplify this task. > +If the package depends on external components, these components might > +be already part of PTXdist. In this case we just have to add this > +dependency into the menu file and we are done. But if PTXdist cannot > +fulfill this dependency, we also must add it as a separate package > +first. > + > +If the *prepare* stage has finished successfully, the next step is to > +compile the package. > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ ptxdist compile foo > + > + ----------------------- > + target: foo.compile > + ----------------------- > + > + make[1]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > + make all-recursive > + make[2]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > + make[3]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > + > + [...] > + > + make[3]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > + make[2]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > + make[1]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > + finished target foo.compile > + > +At this stage things can fail: > + > +- The build system is not cross compile aware (it tries to execute just > + created target binaries for example) > + > +- The package depends on external components (libraries for example) > + not detected by ``configure`` > + > +- Sources are ignoring the endianness of some architectures or using > + header files from the build host system (from ``/usr/include`` for > + example) > + > +- The linker uses libraries from the build host system (from > + ``/usr/lib`` for example) by accident > + > +In all of these cases we must patch the sources to make them work. Refer > +to section :ref:`patching_packages` on how to use PTXdist’s > +features to simplify this task. > + > +In this example we expect the best case: everything went fine, even for > +cross compiling. So, we can continue with the next stage: *install* > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ ptxdist install foo > + > + ----------------------- > + target: foo.install > + ----------------------- > + > + make[1]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > + make[2]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > + make[3]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > + test -z "/usr/bin" || /bin/mkdir -p "/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0/usr/bin" > + /usr/bin/install -c 'foo' '/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0/usr/bin/foo' > + make[3]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > + make[2]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > + make[1]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > + finished target foo.install > + > + ---------------------------- > + target: foo.install.post > + ---------------------------- > + > + finished target foo.install.post > + > +This *install* stage does not install anything to the target root > +filesystem. It is mostly intended to install libraries and header files > +other programs should link against later on. > + > +The last stage – *targetinstall* – is the one that defines the package’s > +components to be forwarded to the target’s root filesystem. Due to the > +absence of a generic way, this is the task of the developer. So, at this > +point of time we must run our favourite editor again and modify our new > +rule file ``./rules/foo.make``. > + > +The skeleton for the *targetinstall* stage looks like this: > + > +.. code-block:: make > + > + # ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- > + # Target-Install > + # ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- > + > + $(STATEDIR)/foo.targetinstall: > + @$(call targetinfo) > + > + @$(call install_init, foo) > + @$(call install_fixup, foo,PACKAGE,foo) > + @$(call install_fixup, foo,PRIORITY,optional) > + @$(call install_fixup, foo,VERSION,$(FOO_VERSION)) > + @$(call install_fixup, foo,SECTION,base) > + @$(call install_fixup, foo,AUTHOR,"My Name <me@my-org.com>") > + @$(call install_fixup, foo,DEPENDS,) > + @$(call install_fixup, foo,DESCRIPTION,missing) > + > + @$(call install_copy, foo, 0, 0, 0755, $(FOO_DIR)/foobar, /dev/null) > + > + @$(call install_finish, foo) > + @$(call touch) > + > +The “header” of this stage defines some information IPKG needs. The > +important part that we must modify is the call to the ``install_copy`` > +macro (refer to section :ref:`reference_macros` for more details > +about this kind of macros). This call instructs PTXdist to include the > +given file (with UID, GID and permissions) into the IPKG, which means to > +install this file to the target’s root filesystem. > + > +From the previous *install* stage we know this package installs an > +executable called ``foo`` to location ``/usr/bin``. We can do the same > +for our target by changing the *install\_copy* line to: > + > +.. code-block:: none > + > + @$(call install_copy, foo, 0, 0, 0755, $(FOO_DIR)/foo, /usr/bin/foo) > + > +To check it, we just run: > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ ptxdist targetinstall foo > + > + ----------------------------- > + target: foo.targetinstall > + ----------------------------- > + > + install_init: preparing for image creation... > + install_init: @ARCH@ -> i386 ... done > + install_init: preinst not available > + install_init: postinst not available > + install_init: prerm not available > + install_init: postrm not available > + install_fixup: @PACKAGE@ -> foo ... done. > + install_fixup: @PRIORITY@ -> optional ... done. > + install_fixup: @VERSION@ -> 1.1.0 ... done. > + install_fixup: @SECTION@ -> base ... done. > + install_fixup: @AUTHOR@ -> "My Name <me\@my-org.com>" ... done. > + install_fixup: @DESCRIPTION@ -> missing ... done. > + install_copy: > + src=/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0/foo > + dst=/usr/bin/foo > + owner=0 > + group=0 > + permissions=0755 > + xpkg_finish: collecting license (unknown) ... done. > + xpkg_finish: creating ipkg package ... done. > + finished target foo.targetinstall > + > + ---------------------------------- > + target: foo.targetinstall.post > + ---------------------------------- > + > + finished target foo.targetinstall.post > + > +After this command, the target’s root filesystem contains a file called > +``/usr/bin/foo`` owned by root, its group is also root and everyone has > +execution permissions, but only the user root has write permissions. > + > +One last task of this port is still open: A reasonable location for > +the new menu entry in PTXdist’s menu hierarchy. PTXdist arranges its > +menus on the meaning of each package. Is it a network related tool? Or > +a scripting language? Or a graphical application? > +Each of these global meanings has its own submenu, where we can add > +our new entry to. We just have to edit the head of our new menu file > +``./rules/foo.in`` to add it to a specific global menu. If our new > +package is a network related tool, the head of the menu file should > +look like: > + > +.. code-block:: kconfig > + > + ## SECTION=networking > + > +We can grep through the other menu files from the PTXdist main > +installation ``rules/`` directory to get an idea what section names are > +available: > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + rules/ $ find . -name \*.in | xargs grep "## SECTION" > + ./acpid.in:## SECTION=shell_and_console > + ./alsa-lib.in:## SECTION=system_libraries > + ./alsa-utils.in:## SECTION=multimedia_sound > + ./apache2.in:## SECTION=networking > + ./apache2_mod_python.in:## SECTION=networking > + [...] > + ./xkeyboard-config.in:## SECTION=multimedia_xorg_data > + ./xorg-app-xev.in:## SECTION=multimedia_xorg_app > + ./xorg-app-xrandr.in:## SECTION=multimedia_xorg_app > + ./host-eggdbus.in:## SECTION=hosttools_noprompt > + ./libssh2.in:## SECTION=networking > + > +Porting a new package to PTXdist is (almost) finished now. > + > +To check it right away, we simply run these two commands: > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ ptxdist clean foo > + rm -rf /home/jbe/my_new_prj/state/foo.* > + rm -rf /home/jbe/my_new_prj/packages/foo_* > + rm -rf /home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0 > + $ ptxdist targetinstall foo > + > + [...] > + > +.. important:: Discover somehow hidden dependencies with one more last check! > + > +Up to this point all the development of the new package was done in an already > +built BSP. Doing so sometimes somehow hidden dependencies cannot be seen: > +everything seems fine, the new package builds always successfully and the > +results are working on the target. > + > +So to check for this kind of dependencies there is still one more final check > +to do (even if its boring and takes time): > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ ptxdist clean > + [...] > + $ ptxdist targetinstall foo > + [...] > + > +This will re-start with a **clean** BSP and builds exactly the new package and > +its (known) dependencies. If this builds successfully as well we are really done > +with the new package. > + > +Some Notes about Licenses > +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > + > +The already mentioned rule variable ``*_LICENSE`` (e.g. ``FOO_LICENSE`` in our > +example) is very important and must be filled by the developer of the package. > +Many licenses bring in obligations using the corresponding package (*attribution* > +for example). To make life easier for everybody the license for a package must > +be provided. *SPDX* license identifiers unify the license names and are used > +in PTXdist to identify license types and obligations. > + > +If a package comes with more than one license, all of their SPDX identifiers > +must be listed and connected with the keyword ``AND``. If your package comes > +with GPL-2.0 and LGPL-2.1 licenses, the definition should look like this: > + > +.. code-block:: make > + > + FOO_LICENSE := GPL-2.0 AND LGPL-2.1 > + > +One specific obligation cannot be detected examining the SPDX license identifiers > +by PTXdist: *the license choice*. In this case all licenses of choice must be > +listed and connected by the keyword ``OR``. > + > +If, for example, your obligation is to select one of the licenses *GPL-2.0* **or** > +*GPL-3.0*, the ``*_LICENSE`` variable should look like this: > + > +.. code-block:: make > + > + FOO_LICENSE := GPL-2.0 OR GPL-3.0 > + > +SPDX License Identifiers > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +A list of SPDX license identifiers can be found here: > + > + https://spdx.org/licenses/ > + > +Help to Detect the Correct License > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +License identification isn't trivial. A help in doing so can be the following > +repository and its content. It contains a list of known licenses based on their > +SPDX identifier. The content is without formatting to simplify text search. > + > + https://github.com/spdx/license-list-data/tree/master/text > + > +Advanced Rule Files > +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > + > +The previous example on how to create a rule file sometimes works as > +shown above. But most of the time source archives are not that simple. > +In this section we want to give the user a more detailed selection how > +the package will be built. > + > +Adding Static Configure Parameters > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +The ``configure`` scripts of various source archives provide additional > +parameters to enable or disable features, or to configure them in a > +specific way. > + > +We assume the ``configure`` script of our ``foo`` example (refer to > +section :ref:`foo_example`) supports two additional parameters: > + > +- **--enable-debug**: Make the program more noisy. It’s disabled by > + default. > + > +- **--with-bar**: Also build the special executable **bar**. Building > + this executable is also disabled by default. > + > +We now want to forward these options to the ``configure`` script when it > +runs in the *prepare* stage. To do so, we must again open the rule file > +with our favourite editor and navigate to the *prepare* stage entry. > + > +PTXdist uses the variable ``FOO_CONF_OPT`` as the list of parameters to > +be given to ``configure``. > + > +Currently this variable is commented out and defined to: > + > +.. code-block:: make > + > + # FOO_CONF_OPT := $(CROSS_AUTOCONF_USR) > + > +The variable ``CROSS_AUTOCONF_USR`` is predefined by PTXdist and > +contains all basic parameters to instruct ``configure`` to prepare for a > +**cross** compile environment. > + > +To use the two additional mentioned ``configure`` parameters, we comment > +in this line and supplement this expression as follows: > + > +.. code-block:: make > + > + FOO_CONF_OPT := \ > + $(CROSS_AUTOCONF_USR) \ > + --enable-debug \ > + --with-bar > + > +.. note:: We recommend to use this format with each parameter on a line of > + its own. This format is easier to read and a diff shows more exactly any > + change. > + > +To do a fast check if this addition was successful, we run: > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ ptxdist print FOO_CONF_OPT > + --prefix=/usr --sysconfdir=/etc --host=|ptxdistCompilerName| --build=i686-host-linux-gnu --enable-debug --with-bar > + > +.. note:: It depends on the currently selected platform and its architecture > + what content this variable will have. The content shown above is an > + example for a target. > + > +Or re-build the package with the new settings: > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ ptxdist drop foo prepare > + $ ptxdist targetinstall foo > + > +Adding Dynamic Configure Parameters > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +Sometimes it makes sense to add this kind of parameters on demand only; > +especially a parameter like ``--enable-debug``. To let the user decide > +if this parameter is to be used or not, we must add a menu entry. So, > +let’s expand our menu. Here is its current content: > + > +.. code-block:: kconfig > + > + ## SECTION=project_specific > + > + config FOO > + tristate > + prompt "foo" > + help > + FIXME > + > +We’ll add two menu entries, one for each optional parameter we want to > +add on demand to the ``configure`` parameters: > + > +.. code-block:: kconfig > + > + ## SECTION=project_specific > + > + config FOO > + tristate > + prompt "foo" > + help > + FIXME > + > + if FOO > + config FOO_DEBUG > + bool > + prompt "add debug noise" > + > + config FOO_BAR > + bool > + prompt "build bar" > + > + endif > + > +.. important:: Always follow the rule to extend the base name by a suboption > + name as the trailing part of the variable name. This gives PTXdist the ability > + to detect a change in the package’s settings (via menuconfig) to force its > + rebuild on demand. > + > +To make usage of the new menu entries, we must check them in the rule > +file and add the correct parameters: > + > +.. code-block:: make > + > + # > + # autoconf > + # > + FOO_CONF_OPT := \ > + $(CROSS_AUTOCONF_USR) \ > + --$(call ptx/endis, PTXCONF_FOO_DEBUG)-debug \ > + --$(call ptx/wwo, PTXCONF_FOO_BAR)-bar > + > +.. important:: Please note the leading ``PTXCONF_`` for each define. While Kconfig is > + using ``FOO_BAR``, the rule file must use ``PTXCONF_FOO_BAR`` instead. > + > +.. note:: Refer :ref:`Rule File Macro Reference <param_macros>` for further > + details about these special kind of option macros (e.g. ``ptx/...``). > + > +It is a good practice to always add both settings, e.g. ``--disable-debug`` > +even if this is the default case. Sometimes ``configure`` tries to guess > +something and the binary result might differ depending on the build > +order. For example some kind of package would also build some X related > +tools, if X libraries are found. In this case it depends on the build > +order, if the X related tools are built or not. All the autocheck > +features are problematic here. So, if we do not want ``configure`` to > +guess its settings we **must disable everything we do not want**. > + > +To support this process, PTXdist supplies a helper script, located at > +``/path/to/ptxdist/scripts/configure-helper.py`` that compares the configure > +output with the settings from ``FOO_CONF_OPT``: > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ /opt/ptxdist-2017.06.0/scripts/configure-helper.py -p libsigrok > + --- rules/libsigrok.make > + +++ libsigrok-0.5.0 > + @@ -4,3 +4,74 @@ > + --libdir=/usr/lib > + --build=x86_64-host-linux-gnu > + --host=arm-v7a-linux-gnueabihf > + + --enable-warnings=min|max|fatal|no > + + --disable-largefile > + + --enable-all-drivers > + + --enable-agilent-dmm > + [...] > + + --enable-ruby > + + --enable-java > + + --without-libserialport > + + --without-libftdi > + + --without-libusb > + + --without-librevisa > + + --without-libgpib > + + --without-libieee1284 > + + --with-jni-include-path=DIR-LIST > + > +In this example, many configure options from libsigrok (marked with ``+``) > +are not yet present in ``LIBSIGROK_CONF_OPT`` and must be added, possibly also > +by providing more dynamic options in the package definition. > + > +If some parts of a package are built on demand only, they must also be > +installed on demand only. Besides the *prepare* stage, we also must > +modify our *targetinstall* stage: > + > +.. code-block:: make > + > + @$(call install_copy, foo, 0, 0, 0755, $(FOO_DIR)/foo, /usr/bin/foo) > + > + ifdef PTXCONF_FOO_BAR > + @$(call install_copy, foo, 0, 0, 0755, $(FOO_DIR)/bar, /usr/bin/bar) > + endif > + > + @$(call install_finish, foo) > + @$(call touch) > + > +Now we can play with our new menu entries and check if they are working > +as expected: > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ ptxdist menuconfig > + $ ptxdist targetinstall foo > + > +Whenever we change a *FOO* related menu entry, PTXdist should detect it > +and re-build the package when a new build is started. > + > +.. _external_dependencies: > + > +Managing External Compile Time Dependencies > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +While running the prepare stage, it could happen that it fails due to a > +missing external dependency. > + > +For example: > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + checking whether zlib exists....failed > + > +In this example, our new package depends on the compression library > +*zlib*. PTXdist comes with a target *zlib*. All we need to do in this > +case is to declare that our new package *foo* depends on *zlib*. This > +kind of dependency is managed in the menu file of our new package by > +simply adding the ``select ZLIB`` line. After this addition our menu > +file looks like: > + > +.. code-block:: kconfig > + > + ## SECTION=project_specific > + > + config FOO > + tristate > + select ZLIB > + prompt "foo" > + help > + FIXME > + > + if FOO > + config FOO_DEBUG > + bool > + prompt "add debug noise" > + > + config FOO_BAR > + bool > + prompt "build bar" > + > + endif > + > +PTXdist now builds the *zlib* first and our new package thereafter. > + > +Refer :ref:`external_dependencies_variants` for more specific dependency > +description. > + > +Managing External Compile Time Dependencies on Demand > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +It is good practice to add only those dependencies that are really > +required for the current configuration of the package. If the package > +provides the features *foo* and *bar* and its ``configure`` provides > +switches to enable/disable them independently, we can also add > +dependencies on demand. Let’s assume feature *foo* needs the compression > +library *libz* and *bar* needs the XML2 library *libxml2*. These > +libraries are only required at run-time if the corresponding feature is > +enabled. To add these dependencies on demand, the menu file looks like: > + > +.. code-block:: kconfig > + > + ## SECTION=project_specific > + > + config FOO > + tristate > + select ZLIB if FOO_FOO > + select LIBXML2 if FOO_BAR > + prompt "foo" > + help > + FIXME > + > + if FOO > + config FOO_DEBUG > + bool > + prompt "add debug noise" > + > + config FOO_FOO > + bool > + prompt "build foo" > + > + config FOO_BAR > + bool > + prompt "build bar" > + > + endif > + > +.. important:: Do not add these ``select`` statements to the corresponding menu entry. > + They must belong to the main menu entry of the package to ensure that > + the calculation of the dependencies between the packages is done in a > + correct manner. > + > +Managing External Runtime Dependencies > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +Some packages are building all of their components and also installing > +them into the target’s sysroot. But only their *targetinstall* stage > +decides which parts are copied to the root filesystem. So, compiling and > +linking of our package will work, because everything required is found > +in the target’s sysroot. > + > +In our example there is a hidden dependency to the math library > +``libm``. Our new package was built successfully, because the linker was > +able to link our binaries against the ``libm`` from the toolchain. But > +in this case the ``libm`` must also be available in the target’s root > +filesystem to fulfil the run-time dependency: We have to force PTXdist to > +install ``libm``. ``libm`` is part of the *glibc* package, but is not > +installed by default (to keep the root filesystem small). So, it **does > +not** help to select the ``GLIBC`` symbol, to get a ``libm`` at run-time. > + > +The correct solution here is to add a ``select LIBC_M`` to our menu > +file. With all the additions above it now looks like: > + > +.. code-block:: kconfig > + > + ## SECTION=project_specific > + > + config FOO > + tristate > + select ZLIB if FOO_FOO > + select LIBXML2 if FOO_BAR > + select LIBC_M > + prompt "foo" > + help > + FIXME > + > + if FOO > + config FOO_DEBUG > + bool > + prompt "add debug noise" > + > + config FOO_FOO > + bool > + prompt "build foo" > + > + config FOO_BAR > + bool > + prompt "build bar" > + > + endif > + > +.. note:: There are other packages around, that do not install everything by > + default. If our new package needs something special, we must take a look > + into the menu of the other package how to force the required components > + to be installed and add the corresponding ``selects`` to our own menu > + file. In this case it does not help to enable the required parts in our > + project configuration, because this has no effect on the build order! > + > +Managing Plain Makefile Packages > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +Many packages are still coming with a plain ``Makefile``. The user has > +to adapt it to make it work in a cross compile environment as well. > +PTXdist can also handle this kind of packages. We only have to specify > +a special *prepare* and *compile* stage. > + > +Such packages often have no special need for any kind of preparation. In > +this we must instruct PTXdist to do nothing in the *prepare* stage: > + > +.. code-block:: make > + > + FOO_CONF_TOOL := NO > + > +To compile the package, we can use ``make``\ ’s feature to overwrite > +variables used in the ``Makefile``. With this feature we can still use > +the original ``Makefile`` but with our own (cross compile) settings. > + > +Most of the time the generic compile rule can be used, only a few > +settings are required. For a well defined ``Makefile`` it is sufficient to > +set up the correct cross compile environment for the *compile* stage: > + > +.. code-block:: make > + > + FOO_MAKE_ENV := $(CROSS_ENV) > + > +``make`` will be called in this case with: > + > +``$(FOO_MAKE_ENV) $(MAKE) -C $(FOO_DIR) $(FOO_MAKE_OPT)`` > + > +So, in the rule file only the two variables ``FOO_MAKE_ENV`` and > +``FOO_MAKE_OPT`` must be set, to forward the required settings to the > +package’s buildsystem. If the package cannot be built in parallel, we > +can also add the ``FOO_MAKE_PAR := NO``. ``YES`` is the default. > + > +Managing CMake/QMake/Meson Packages > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +Building packages that use ``cmake``, ``qmake`` or ``meson`` is much like > +building packages with an autotools based buildsystem. We need to specify > +the configuration tool: > + > +.. code-block:: make > + > + FOO_CONF_TOOL := cmake > + > +or > + > +.. code-block:: make > + > + FOO_CONF_TOOL := qmake > + > +or respectively > + > +.. code-block:: make > + > + FOO_CONF_TOOL := meson > + > +And provide the correct configuration options. The syntax is different so > +PTXdist provides additional macros to simplify configurable features. > +For ``cmake`` the configuration options typically look like this: > + > +.. code-block:: make > + > + FOO_CONF_OPT := \ > + $(CROSS_CMAKE_USR) \ > + -DBUILD_TESTS:BOOL=OFF \ > + -DENABLE_BAR:BOOL=$(call ptx/onoff, PTXCONF_FOO_BAR) > + > +For ``qmake`` the configuration options typically look like this: > + > +.. code-block:: make > + > + FOO_CONF_OPT := \ > + $(CROSS_QMAKE_OPT) \ > + PREFIX=/usr > + > +And for ``meson`` the configuration options typically look like this: > + > +.. code-block:: make > + > + FOO_CONF_OPT := \ > + $(CROSS_MESON_USR) \ > + -Dbar=$(call ptx/truefalse,PTXCONF_FOO_BAR) > + > +Please note that currently only host and target ``cmake``\/``meson`` packages > +and only target ``qmake`` packages are supported. > + > +Managing Python Packages > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +As with any other package, the correct configuration tool must be selected > +for Python packages: > + > +.. code-block:: make > + > + FOO_CONF_TOOL := python > + > +.. note:: For Python3 packages the value must be ``python3``. > + > +No Makefiles are used when building Python packages so the usual ``make`` > +and ``make install`` for the *compile* and *install* stages cannot be used. > +PTXdist will call ``python setup.py build`` and ``python setup.py install`` > +instead. > + > +.. note:: *FOO* is still the name of our example package. It must be > + replaced by the real package name. > + > + > +.. _patching_packages: > + > +Patching Packages > +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > + > +There can be various reasons why a package must be patched: > + > +- Package is broken for cross compile environments > + > +- Package is broken within a specific feature > + > +- Package is vulnerable and needs some fixes > + > +- or anything else (this case is the most common one) > + > +Ideally, those problems should be addressed in the original project, > +so any patches you add to your BSP or to PTXdist should also be submitted upstream. > +The upstream project can often provide better feedback, they can integrate your > +patch into a new release, and also maintain your changes as part of the project. > +This way we make sure that all advantages of the open source idea work for us; > +and your patch can be removed again later when a new release of the project is > +integrated into your BSP or into PTXdist. > + > +PTXdist handles patching automatically. > +After extracting the archive of a package, PTXdist checks for the existence of > +a patch directory named like its ``<PKG>_PATCHES`` variable, or, if this variable > +is not set, like its ``<PKG>`` variable. > +The patch directory is then searched in all locations listed by the > +``PTXDIST_PATH_PATCHES`` variable, and the first one found is used. > +Take an exemplary package ``foo`` with version ``1.1.0``: > +The variable ``FOO`` will have the value ``foo-1.1.0``, so PTXdist will look for > +a patch directory named ``foo-1.1.0`` in the following locations: > + > +#. the current layer: > + > + a. project (``./patches/foo-1.1.0``) > + b. platform (``./configs/|ptxdistPlatformConfigDir|/patches/foo-1.1.0``) > + > +#. any :ref:`base layers <layers-in-ptxdist>`, > + applying the same search order as above for each layer recursively > + > +#. ptxdist (``<ptxdist/installation/path>/patches/foo-1.1.0``) > + > +The patches from the first location found are used. Note: Due to this > +search order, a PTXdist project can replace global patches from the > +PTXdist installation. This can be useful if a project sticks to a > +specific PTXdist revision but fixes from a more recent revision of > +PTXdist should be used. > + > +PTXdist uses the utilities *git*, *patch* or *quilt* to work with > +patches or patch series. We recommend *git*, as it can manage patch > +series in a very easy way. > + > +Creating a Patch Series for a Package > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +To create a patch series for the first time, we can run the following > +steps. We are still using our *foo-1.1.0* example package here: > + > +Using Quilt > +""""""""""" > + > +We create a special directory for the patch series in the local project > +directory: > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ mkdir -p patches/foo-1.1.0 > + > +PTXdist expects a ``series`` file in the patch directory and at least > +one patch. Otherwise it fails. Due to the fact that we do not have any > +patch content yet, we’ll start with a dummy entry in the ``series`` file > +and an empty ``patch`` file. > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ touch patches/foo-1.1.0/dummy > + $ echo dummy > patches/foo-1.1.0/series > + > +Next is to extract the package (if already done, we must remove it > +first): > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ ptxdist extract foo > + > +This will extract the archive and create a symbolic link in the build > +directory pointing to our local patch directory. Working this way will > +ensure that we do not lose our created patches if we enter > +``ptxdist clean foo`` by accident. In our case the patches are still > +present in ``patches/foo-1.1.0`` and can be used the next time we > +extract the package again. > + > +All we have to do now is to do the modification we need to make the > +package work. We change into the build directory and use quilt_ to > +create new patches, add files to respective patches, modify these files > +and refresh the patches to save our changes. > +See the *quilt* documentation (``man 1 quilt``) for more information. > + > +.. note:: For patches that are intended for PTXdist upstream use the git > + workflow described below to get proper patch headers. > + > +.. _quilt: http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/quilt > + > +Using Git > +""""""""" > + > +Create the patch directory like above for *quilt*, > +but only add an empty series file: > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ mkdir -p patches/foo-1.1.0 > + $ touch patches/foo-1.1.0/series > + > +Then extract the package with an additional command line switch: > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ ptxdist --git extract foo > + > +The empty series file makes PTXdist create a Git repository in the > +respective package build directory, > +and import the package source as the first commit. > + > +.. note:: Optionally, you can enable the setting *Developer Options → > + use git to apply patches* in `ptxdist setup` to get this behaviour > + as a default for every package. > + However, note that this setting is meant for development only, and can lead > + to failures – some packages try to determine if they are being compiled from > + a Git source tree, and behave differently in that case. > + > +Then you can change into the package build directory > +(``platform-<name>/build-target/foo-1.1.0``), > +patch the required source files, > +and make Git commits on the way. > +The Git history should now look something like this: > + > +.. code-block:: text > + > + $ git log --oneline --decorate > + * df343e821851 (HEAD -> master) Makefile: don't build the tests > + * 65a360c2bd60 strfry.c: frobnicate the excusator > + * fdc315f6844c (tag: foobar-1.1.0, tag: base) initial commit > + > +Finally, call ``git ptx-patches`` to transform those Git commits into the patch > +series in the ``patches/foo-1.1.0`` folder. > +This way they don't get lost when cleaning the package. > + > +.. note:: PTXdist will only create a Git repository for packages with > + patches. To use Git to generate the first patch, create an empty series > + file ``patches/foobar-1.1.0/series`` before extracting the packages. This > + will tell PTXdist to use Git anyways and ``git ptx-patches`` will put the > + patches there. > + > +Both approaches (Git and quilt) are not suitable for modifying files > +that are autogenerated in autotools-based buildsystems. > +Refer to the section :ref:`configure_rebuild` on how PTXdist can > +handle this special task. > + > +Adding More Patches to a Package > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +If we want to add more patches to an already patched package, we can use > +nearly the same way as creating patches for the first time. But if the > +patch series comes from the PTXdist main installation, we do not have > +write permissions to these directories (do NEVER work on the main > +installation directories, NEVER, NEVER, NEVER). Due to the search order > +in which PTXdist searches for patches for a specific package, we can > +copy the global patch series to our local project directory. Now we have > +the permissions to add more patches or modify the existing ones. Also > +*quilt* and *git* are our friends here to manage the patch series. > + > +If we think that our new patches are valuable also for others, or they > +fix an error, it could be a good idea to send these patches to PTXdist > +mainline, and to the upstream project too. > + > + > +.. _configure_rebuild: > + > +Modifying Autotoolized Packages > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +Autotoolized packages are very picky when automatically generated files > +get patched. The patch order is very important in this case and > +sometimes it even fails and nobody knows why. > + > +To improve a package’s autotools-based build system, PTXdist comes with > +its own project local autotools to regenerate the autotools template > +files, instead of patching them. With this feature, only the template > +files must be patched, the required ``configure`` script and the > +``Makefile.in`` files are regenerated in the final stages of the > +*prepare* step. > + > +This feature works like the regular patching mechanism. The only > +difference is the additional ``autogen.sh`` file in the patch directory. > +If it exists and has execution permissions, it will be called after the > +package was patched (while the *extract* stage is running). > + > +Its content depends on developer needs; for the most simple case the > +content can be: > + > +.. code-block:: bash > + > + #!/bin/bash > + > + aclocal $ACLOCAL_FLAGS > + > + libtoolize \ > + --force \ > + --copy > + > + autoreconf \ > + --force \ > + --install \ > + --warnings=cross \ > + --warnings=syntax \ > + --warnings=obsolete \ > + --warnings=unsupported > + > +.. note:: In this way not yet autotoolized package can be autotoolized. We > + just have to add the common autotool template files (``configure.ac`` > + and ``Makefile.am`` for example) via a patch series to the package > + source and the ``autogen.sh`` to the patch directory. > diff --git a/doc/dev_create_new_pkg_templates.rst b/doc/dev_create_new_pkg_templates.rst > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000000..d7c2927b6846 > --- /dev/null > +++ b/doc/dev_create_new_pkg_templates.rst > @@ -0,0 +1,77 @@ > +Creating New Package Templates > +------------------------------ > + > +For larger projects it can be convenient to have project specific package > +templates. This can be achieved by either modifying existing templates or > +by creating completely new templates. > + > +Modifying a Template > +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > + > +A template can be modified by providing new input files. This is easier > +than creating a new template but does not allow to specify new variables to > +substitute in the input files. > + > +PTXdist looks for template files the same way it looks for rules files. The > +only difference is, that it searches in the ``templates/`` subdirectory. > +So a modified ``./rules/templates/template-target-make`` can be used to > +tweak the ``target`` template. > + > +Creating a New Template > +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > + > +For a completely new template, some bash scripting is required. All shell > +code must be placed in a file named like this: > +``./scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_*.sh``. > + > +The minimum requirement for a new template is: > +- a shell function that creates the new package > +- registering the new template > + > +.. code-block:: sh > + > + ptxd_template_new_mypkg() { > + # create the package here > + } > + export -f ptxd_template_new_mypkg > + ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="mypkg" > + ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="create awesome mypkg package" > + > +PTXdist provides several helper functions to simplify the template. > +Using those functions, the package creation process is split into two > +parts: > + > +- query the user for input and export variables. > +- create the new package files from the template source files by > + substituting all instances of ``@<variable>@`` with the value of the > + corresponding variable. > + > +A simple template function could look like this: > + > +.. code-block:: sh > + > + ptxd_template_new_mypkg() { > + ptxd_template_read_basic && > + ptxd_template_read "enter download section" DL_SECTION "foobar" > + ptxd_template_read_author && > + export section="local_${dlsection}" && > + ptxd_template_write_rules > + } > + > +This template requires ``rules/templates/template-mypkg-make`` and > +``rules/templates/template-mypkg-in`` as source files. They could be > +derived from the ``target`` template with a simple modification: > + > +.. code-block:: make > + > + @PACKAGE@_SUFFIX := tar.xz > + @PACKAGE@_URL := http://dl.my-company.local/downloads/@DL_SECTION@/$(@PACKAGE@).$(@PACKAGE@_SUFFIX) > + > +The helper functions that are used in the example above are defined in > +``scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh`` in the PTXdist source tree. > + > +The template is a normal shell function. Arbitrary things can be done here > +to create the new package. The helper functions are just the most > +convenient way to crate simple templates. It is also possible to create > +more files. For examples, the builtin ``genimage`` template creates a extra > +config file for the new package. > diff --git a/doc/dev_dir_hierarchy.rst b/doc/dev_dir_hierarchy.rst > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000000..bd1ad40d0c19 > --- /dev/null > +++ b/doc/dev_dir_hierarchy.rst > @@ -0,0 +1,108 @@ > +.. _directory_hierarchy: > + > +PTXdist’s Directory Hierarchy > +----------------------------- > + > +.. note:: Referenced directories are meant relative to the PTXdist main > + installation location (if not otherwise stated). If not configured > + differently, this main path is ``/usr/local/lib/ptxdist-|ptxdistVendorVersion|`` > + > +Rule Files > +~~~~~~~~~~ > + > +When building a single package, PTXdist needs the information on how to > +handle the package, i.e. on how to get it from the source up to what the > +target needs at run-time. This information is provided by a rule file per > +package. > + > +PTXdist collects all rule files in its ``rules/`` directory. Whenever > +PTXdist builds something, all these rule files are scanned at once. > +These rule files are global rule files, valid for all projects. PTXdist > +uses a mechanism to be able to add or replace specific rule files on a > +per project base. If a ``rules/`` directory exists in the current > +project, its content is scanned too. These project local rule files are > +used in addition to the global rule files or – if they are using the > +same name as a global rule file – **replacing** the global rule file. > + > +The replacing mechanism can be used to extend or adapt packages for > +specific project requirements. Or it can be used for bug fixing by > +backporting rule files from more recent PTXdist revisions to projects > +that are stuck to an older PTXdist revision for maintenance only. > + > +Patch Series > +~~~~~~~~~~~~ > + > +There are many packages in the wild that are not cross build aware. They > +fail compiling some files, use wrong include paths or try to link > +against host libraries. To be successful in the embedded world, these > +types of failures must be fixed. If required, PTXdist provides such > +fixes per package. They are organized in *patch series* and can be found > +in a ``patches/`` directory within a subdirectory using the same name > +as the package itself. > + > +PTXdist uses the utility ``patch`` or ``quilt`` (or ``git`` on demand) to apply > +an existing patch series after extracting the archive. So, every patch series > +contains a set of patches and one ``series`` file to define the order in > +which the patches must be applied. > + > +.. note:: Patches can be compressed. > + > +Patches are looked for at several locations: > + > +1. the ``patches/`` folder in your BSP (``${PTXDIST_WORKSPACE}/patches``) > + > +2. the folder ``patches/`` folder relative to your selected platformconfig > + file (``${PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR}/patches``). If your platformconfig > + file is at ``configs/|ptxdistPlatformConfigDir|/platformconfig``, this > + patch folder will be ``configs/|ptxdistPlatformConfigDir|/patches/``. > + > +3. the ``patches/`` folder in PTXdist's main installation directory > + (``${PTXDIST_TOPDIR}/patches``) > + > +The list is tried from first to last. > +If no patches were found in one of the locations, the next location is tried. > +When all locations have been tried unsuccessfully, the package is not patched. > + > +This search order can be used to use specific patch series for specific > +cases. > + > +- platform specific > + > +- project specific > + > +- common case > + > +- bug fixing > + > +The *bug fixing* case is used in accordance to a replacement of a rule > +file. If this was done due to a backport, and the more recent PTXdist > +revision does not only exchange the rule file but also the patch series, > +this mechanism ensures that both relevant parts can be updated in the > +project. > + > +Runtime Configuration > +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > + > +Many packages are using run-time configuration files along with their > +executables and libraries. PTXdist provides default configuration files > +for the most common cases. These files can be found in the > +``projectroot/etc`` directory and they are using the same names as the ones > +at run-time (and their install directory on the target side will also be > +``/etc``). > + > +But some of these default configuration files are empty, due to the > +absence of a common case. The project must provide replacements of these > +files with a more useful content in every case where the (empty) default > +one does not meet the target’s requirements. > + > +PTXdist first searches in the local project directory for a specific > +configuration file and falls back to use the default one if none exists > +locally. Refer section :ref:`install_alternative` for further > +details in which order and locations PTXdist searches for these kind of files. > + > +A popular example is the configuration file ``/etc/fstab``. The default > +one coming with PTXdist works for the most common cases. But if our > +project requires a special setup, we can just copy the default one to > +the local ``./projectroot/etc/fstab``, modify it and we are done. The > +next time PTXdist builds the root filesystem it will use the local > +``fstab`` instead of the global (default) one. > diff --git a/doc/dev_layers_in_ptxdist.rst b/doc/dev_layers_in_ptxdist.rst > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000000..ec92c8c8a86c > --- /dev/null > +++ b/doc/dev_layers_in_ptxdist.rst > @@ -0,0 +1,111 @@ > +.. _layers-in-ptxdist: > + > +Layers in PTXdist > +----------------- > + > +For better maintenance or other reasons, a PTXdist project can be split > +into multiple layers. Each layer has exactly the same directory hierarchy > +as described in :ref:`directory_hierarchy` and other chapters. > + > +All layers are explicitly stacked in the filesystem. The top layer is the > +workspace of the PTXdist project. Any ``selected_*`` links and the platform > +build directory are created here. The layer below is defined by the > +subdirectory or symlink named ``base/``. More can be stacked the same > +way, so ``base/base/`` is the third layer and so on. > +In many ways, PTXdist itself can be considered as the bottom layer. This is > +either implicit or explicit with one last ``base/`` symlink. > + > +A project can overwrite files provided by PTXdist in many different ways, > +e.g. rule files or files installed with :ref:`install_alternative` etc. > +This concept expands naturally to layers. Each layer can overwrite files > +provided by lower layers in the exact same way. Any files are always > +searched for in a strict layer by layer order. > + > +Writing Layer Aware Rules > +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > + > +For the most part, package rules work just as expected when multiple layers > +are used. Any layer specific handling is done implicitly by PTXdist. > +However, there are a few things that need special handling. > + > +The variables :ref:`PTXDIST_WORKSPACE<ptxdist_workspace>` and > +:ref:`PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR`<ptxdist_platformconfigdir>` always refer > +to the directories in the top layer. These variables might be used in rules > +files like this: > + > +.. code-block:: make > + > + MY_KERNEL_CONFIG := $(PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR)/kernelconfig.special > + > +If the referenced file is in any layer but the top one then it will not > +be found. To handle use-cases like this, the macros :ref:`in_path` and > +:ref:`in_platformconfigdir` can be used: > + > +.. code-block:: make > + > + MY_KERNEL_CONFIG := $(call ptx/in-platformconfigdir, kernelconfig.special) > + > +This way, the layers are searched top to bottom until the config file is > +found. > + > +PTXdist Config Files with Multiple Layers > +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > + > +In many cases a layer may want to modify the **ptxconfig** by enabling or > +disabling some options. Any changes must be propagated through the whole > +layer stack. > + > +The features and workflow described here apply to the **ptxconfig**, the > +**platformconfig** and any **collectionconfig** used in the project. > + > +To do this, PTXdist stores a delta config to the layer below and a full > +config file in each layer. If the two files are missing then the config is > +unchanged. The bottom layer has only the config file and no delta. > + > +At runtime, PTXdist will always use the full config file in the top layer > +where the config exists. Before doing so, it will ensure that the config is > +consistent across all layers. This means that, for any layer that contains a > +delta config, the full config file of the layer below has not changed since > +the delta config was last updated. If any inconsistency is detected, > +PTXdist will abort. > + > +For any command that modifies the config file, except ``oldconfig``, > +PTXdist will use kconfig implicitly on all layers to check if the config > +for this layer is up to date. This is a stricter check than the consistency > +validation. For example, if a new package was added to a layer without > +updating the **ptxconfig** then this will be detected and PTXdist will > +abort. If all other layers are up to date, then PTXdist will use the delta > +config of the top layer, apply it to the full config of the layer below > +and execute the specified command with the resulting config file. > + > +.. note:: If the config file does not exist yet on the top layer, then it > + will be created if changes to the config are made. Similarly the config > + will be deleted if the delta is empty after the changes. In either case > + it may be necessary to update any ``selected_*`` link to point to the > + correct config. > + > +If PTXdist detects an inconsistency or an out of date config file then it > +must be updated before they can be used. This can be done by using the > +``oldconfig`` command. In this special case, PTXdist will iterate from the > +bottom to the top layer and run ``oldconfig`` for each of them. It will > +use the delta config applied to the full config of the layer below at each > +step. This means that it's possible to enable or disable a option in the > +bottom layer and ``oldconfig`` will propagate this change to all other > +layers. > + > +Packages with kconfig Based Config Files > +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > + > +For packages such as the Linux kernel that have kconfig based config files, > +a lot of the infrastructure to handle config files and deltas across > +multiple layers can be reused. Consistency validation is done implicitly > +and ``menuconfig`` and other kconfig commands will use config files and > +deltas as expected. > + > +It's not possible to implicitly run ``oldconfig`` on other layers (this may > +require a different source tree for the packages), so any inconsistencies > +must be resolved manually by running ``oldconfig`` explicitly on each > +layer. > + > +The make macros that provide these features are currently used by the > +barebox and kernel packages and templates. > diff --git a/doc/dev_manual.rst b/doc/dev_manual.rst > index 50827b6a9cdd..47a77a9be62f 100644 > --- a/doc/dev_manual.rst > +++ b/doc/dev_manual.rst > @@ -5,1758 +5,12 @@ PTXdist Developer’s Manual > > This chapter shows all (or most) of the details of how PTXdist works. > > -- where are the files stored that PTXdist uses when building packages > - > -- how patching works > - > -- where is PTXdist fetching a package’s run-time configuration files > - from > - > -- how to control a package’s build stages > - > -- how to add new packages > - > -.. _directory_hierarchy: > - > -PTXdist’s Directory Hierarchy > ------------------------------ > - > -.. note:: Referenced directories are meant relative to the PTXdist main > - installation location (if not otherwise stated). If not configured > - differently, this main path is ``/usr/local/lib/ptxdist-|ptxdistVendorVersion|`` > - > -Rule Files > -~~~~~~~~~~ > - > -When building a single package, PTXdist needs the information on how to > -handle the package, i.e. on how to get it from the source up to what the > -target needs at run-time. This information is provided by a rule file per > -package. > - > -PTXdist collects all rule files in its ``rules/`` directory. Whenever > -PTXdist builds something, all these rule files are scanned at once. > -These rule files are global rule files, valid for all projects. PTXdist > -uses a mechanism to be able to add or replace specific rule files on a > -per project base. If a ``rules/`` directory exists in the current > -project, its content is scanned too. These project local rule files are > -used in addition to the global rule files or – if they are using the > -same name as a global rule file – **replacing** the global rule file. > - > -The replacing mechanism can be used to extend or adapt packages for > -specific project requirements. Or it can be used for bug fixing by > -backporting rule files from more recent PTXdist revisions to projects > -that are stuck to an older PTXdist revision for maintenance only. > - > -Patch Series > -~~~~~~~~~~~~ > - > -There are many packages in the wild that are not cross build aware. They > -fail compiling some files, use wrong include paths or try to link > -against host libraries. To be successful in the embedded world, these > -types of failures must be fixed. If required, PTXdist provides such > -fixes per package. They are organized in *patch series* and can be found > -in a ``patches/`` directory within a subdirectory using the same name > -as the package itself. > - > -PTXdist uses the utility ``patch`` or ``quilt`` (or ``git`` on demand) to apply > -an existing patch series after extracting the archive. So, every patch series > -contains a set of patches and one ``series`` file to define the order in > -which the patches must be applied. > - > -.. note:: Patches can be compressed. > - > -Patches are looked for at several locations: > - > -1. the ``patches/`` folder in your BSP (``${PTXDIST_WORKSPACE}/patches``) > - > -2. the folder ``patches/`` folder relative to your selected platformconfig > - file (``${PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR}/patches``). If your platformconfig > - file is at ``configs/|ptxdistPlatformConfigDir|/platformconfig``, this > - patch folder will be ``configs/|ptxdistPlatformConfigDir|/patches/``. > - > -3. the ``patches/`` folder in PTXdist's main installation directory > - (``${PTXDIST_TOPDIR}/patches``) > - > -The list is tried from first to last. > -If no patches were found in one of the locations, the next location is tried. > -When all locations have been tried unsuccessfully, the package is not patched. > - > -This search order can be used to use specific patch series for specific > -cases. > - > -- platform specific > - > -- project specific > - > -- common case > - > -- bug fixing > - > -The *bug fixing* case is used in accordance to a replacement of a rule > -file. If this was done due to a backport, and the more recent PTXdist > -revision does not only exchange the rule file but also the patch series, > -this mechanism ensures that both relevant parts can be updated in the > -project. > - > -Runtime Configuration > -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > - > -Many packages are using run-time configuration files along with their > -executables and libraries. PTXdist provides default configuration files > -for the most common cases. These files can be found in the > -``projectroot/etc`` directory and they are using the same names as the ones > -at run-time (and their install directory on the target side will also be > -``/etc``). > - > -But some of these default configuration files are empty, due to the > -absence of a common case. The project must provide replacements of these > -files with a more useful content in every case where the (empty) default > -one does not meet the target’s requirements. > - > -PTXdist first searches in the local project directory for a specific > -configuration file and falls back to use the default one if none exists > -locally. Refer section :ref:`install_alternative` for further > -details in which order and locations PTXdist searches for these kind of files. > - > -A popular example is the configuration file ``/etc/fstab``. The default > -one coming with PTXdist works for the most common cases. But if our > -project requires a special setup, we can just copy the default one to > -the local ``./projectroot/etc/fstab``, modify it and we are done. The > -next time PTXdist builds the root filesystem it will use the local > -``fstab`` instead of the global (default) one. > - > -.. _adding_new_packages: > - > -Adding New Packages > -------------------- > - > -PTXdist provides a huge amount of applications sufficient for the most > -embedded use cases. But there is still need for some fancy new packages. > -This section describes the steps and the background on how to integrate > -new packages into the project. > - > -At first a summary about possible application types which PTXdist can > -handle: > - > -- **host type**: This kind of package is built to run on the build > - host. Most of the time such a package is needed if another > - target-relevant package needs to generate some data. For example the > - *glib* package depends on its own to create some data. But if it is > - compiled for the target, it can’t do so. That’s why a host glib > - package is required to provide these utilities runnable on the build > - host. It sounds strange to build a host package, even if on the build > - host such utilities are already installed. But this way ensures that > - there are no dependencies regarding the build host system. > - > -- **target type**: This kind of package is built for the target. > - > -- **cross type**: This kind of package is built for the build host, but > - creates architecture specific data for the target. > - > -- **src-autoconf-prog**: This kind of package is built for the target. > - It is intended for development, as it does not handle a released > - archive but a plain source project instead. Creating such a package > - will also create a small autotools based source template project on > - demand to give the developer an easy point to start. This template is > - prepared to build a single executable program. For further details refer > - section :ref:`adding_src_autoconf_exec`. > - > -- **src-autoconf-lib**: This kind of package is built for the target. > - It is intended for development, as it does not handle a released > - archive but a plain source project instead. Creating such a package > - will also create a small autotools/libtool based source template > - project on demand to give the developer an easy point to start. This > - template is prepared to build a single shared library. For further > - details refer section :ref:`adding_src_autoconf_lib`. > - > -- **src-autoconf-proglib**: This kind of package is built for the > - target. It is intended for development, as it does not handle a > - released archive but a plain source project instead. Creating such a > - package will also create a small autotools/libtool based template > - project on demand to give the developer an easy point to start. This > - template is prepared to build a single shared library and a single > - executable program. The program will be linked against the shared > - library. For further details refer section :ref:`adding_src_autoconf_exec_lib`. > - > -- **file**: This kind of package is intended to add a few simple files > - into the build process. We assume these files do not need any > - processing, they are ready to use and must only be present in the > - build process or at run-time (HTML files for example). Refer to the > - section :ref:`adding_files` for further details on how to use > - it. > - > -- **src-make-prog**: This kind of package is built for the target. It’s > - intended for development, as it does not handle a released archive > - but a plain source project instead. Creating such a package will also > - create a simple makefile-based template project the developer can use > - as a starting point for development. > - > -- **src-cmake-prog**: This kind of package is built for the target. > - It’s intended for developments based on the *cmake* buildsystem. > - Various projects are using *cmake* instead of *make* and can be built > - with this package type. PTXdist will prepare it to compile sources in > - accordance to the target libraries and their settings. Creating such > - a package will also create a simple template project to be used as a > - starting point for development. > - > -- **src-qmake-prog**: This kind of package is built for the target. > - It’s intended for developments based on the *qmake* buildsystem. If > - the developer is going to develop a QT based application, this rule > - is prepared to compile sources in accordance to the target libraries > - and their settings. Creating such a package will also create a simple > - template project to be used as a starting point for development. > - > -- **src-meson-prog**: This kind of package is built for the target. > - It’s intended for developments based on the *meson* buildsystem. > - Various projects are using *meson* today and can be built > - with this package type. PTXdist will prepare it to compile sources in > - accordance to the target libraries and their settings. Creating such > - a package will also create a simple template project to be used as a > - starting point for development. > - > -- **font**: This package is a helper to add X font files to the root > - filesystem. This package does not create an additional IPKG, instead > - it adds the font to the existing font IPKG. This includes the > - generation of the directory index files, required by the Xorg > - framework to recognize the font file. > - > -- **src-linux-driver**: This kind of package builds an out of tree > - kernel driver. It also creates a driver template to give the > - developer an easy point to start. > - > -- **kernel**: PTXdist comes with the ability to handle one kernel in its > - platform. This type of package enables us to handle more than one kernel in > - the project. > - > -- **barebox**: PTXdist comes with the ability to handle one bootloader in its > - platform. This type of package enables us to handle more than one bootloader > - in the project. > - > -- **image-tgz**: This kind of package creates a tar ball from a list of > - packages. It is often uses as an input for other image packages. > - > -- **image-genimage**: This kind of package can handle all kind of image > - generation for almost every target independent of its complexity. > - > -- **blspec-entry**: PTXdist comes with the ability to handle one bootspec in its > - platform. This type of package enables us to handle more than one bootspec > - in the project. > - > -.. _foo_example: > - > -Rule File Creation > -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > - > -To create such a new package, we create a project local ``rules/`` > -directory first. Then we run > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ ptxdist newpackage <package type> > - > -If we omit the <``package type``\ >, PTXdist will list all available > -package types. > - > -In our first example, we want to add a new target type archive package. > -When running the > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ ptxdist newpackage target > - > -command, PTXdist asks a few questions about this package. This > -information is the basic data PTXdist must know about the package. > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - ptxdist: creating a new 'target' package: > - > - ptxdist: enter package name.......: foo > - ptxdist: enter version number.....: 1.1.0 > - ptxdist: enter URL of basedir.....: http://www.foo.com/download/src > - ptxdist: enter suffix.............: tar.gz > - ptxdist: enter package author.....: My Name <me@my-org.com> > - ptxdist: enter package section....: project_specific > - > -What we have to answer: > - > -- **package name**: As this kind of package handles a source archive, > - the correct answer here is the basename of the archive’s file name. > - If its full name is ``foo-1.1.0.tar.gz``, then ``foo`` is the > - basename to enter here. > - > -- **version number**: Most source archives are using a release or > - version number in their file name. If its full name is > - ``foo-1.1.0.tar.gz``, then ``1.1.0`` is the version number to enter > - here. > - > -- **URL of basedir**: This URL tells PTXdist where to download the > - source archive from the web (if not already done). If the full URL to > - download the archive is > - ``http://www.foo.com/download/src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz``, the basedir > - part ``http://www.foo.com/download/src`` is to be entered here. > - > -- **suffix**: Archives are using various formats for distribution. > - PTXdist uses the *suffix* entry to select the matching extraction > - tool. If the archive’s full name is ``foo-1.1.0.tar.gz``, then > - ``tar.gz`` is the suffix to enter here. > - > -- **package author**: If we intend to contribute this new package to > - PTXdist mainline, we should add our name here. This name will be used > - in the copyright note of the rule file and will also be added to the > - generated ipkg. When you run ``ptxdist setup`` prior to this call, > - you can enter your name and your email address, so PTXdist will use > - it as the default (very handy if you intend to add many new > - packages). > - > -- **package section**: We can enter here the menu section name where > - our new package menu entry should be listed. In the first step we can > - leave the default name unchanged. It’s a string in the menu file > - only, so changing it later on is still possible. > - > -Make it Work > -~~~~~~~~~~~~ > - > -Generating the rule file is only one of the required steps to get a new > -package. The next steps to make it work are to check if all stages are > -working as expected and to select the required parts to get them > -installed in the target root filesystem. Also we must find a reasonable > -location where to add our new menu entry to configure the package. > - > -The generated skeleton starts to add the new menu entry in the main > -configure menu (if we left the section name unchanged). Running > -``ptxdist menuconfig`` will show it on top of all other menus entries. > - > -.. important:: > - To be able to implement and test all the other required steps for adding > - a new package, we first must enable the package for building. (Fine > - tuning the menu can happen later on.) > - > - > -The rule file skeleton still lacks some important information. Let’s > -take a look into some of the top lines of the generated rule file > -``./rules/foo.make``: > - > -.. code-block:: make > - > - FOO_VERSION := 1.1.0 > - FOO_MD5 := > - FOO := foo-$(FOO_VERSION) > - FOO_SUFFIX := tar.gz > - FOO_URL := http://www.foo.com/download/src/$(FOO).$(FOO_SUFFIX) > - FOO_SOURCE := $(SRCDIR)/$(FOO).$(FOO_SUFFIX) > - FOO_DIR := $(BUILDDIR)/$(FOO) > - FOO_LICENSE := unknown > - > -We can find these lines with different content in most or all of the > -other rule files PTXdist comes with. Up to the underline character is > -always the package name and after the underline character is always > -PTXdist specific. What does it mean: > - > -- ``*_VERSION`` brings in the version number of the release and is used > - for the download and IPKG/OPKG package generation. > - > -- ``*_MD5`` to be sure the correct package has been downloaded, PTXdist > - checks the given MD5 sum against the archive content. If both sums do > - not match, PTXdist rejects the archive and fails the currently > - running build. > - > -- ``*_SUFFIX`` defines the archive type, to make PTXdist choosing the > - correct extracting tool. > - > -- ``*_URL`` defines the full qualified URL into the web for download. If > - alternative download locations are known, they can be listed in this > - variable, delimiter character is the space. > - > -- ``*_SOURCE`` tells PTXdist where to store the downloaded package. > - > -- ``*_DIR`` points to the directory this package will be built later on > - by PTXdist. > - > -- ``*_LICENSE`` enables the user to get a list of licenses she/he is > - using in her/his project (licenses of the enabled packages). > - > -After enabling the menu entry, we can start to check the *get* and > -*extract* stages, calling them manually one after another. > - > -.. note:: The shown commands below expect that PTXdist downloads the > - archives to a global directory named ``global_src``. This is not the > - default setting, but we recommend to use a global directory to share all > - archives between PTXdist based projects. Advantage is every download > - happens only once. Refer to the ``setup`` command PTXdist provides. > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ ptxdist get foo > - > - --------------------------- > - target: foo-1.1.0.tar.gz > - --------------------------- > - > - --2009-12-21 10:54:45-- http://www.foo.com/download/src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz > - Length: 291190 (284K) [application/x-gzip] > - Saving to: `/global_src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz.XXXXOGncZA' > - > - 100%[======================================>] 291,190 170K/s in 1.7s > - > - 2009-12-21 10:54:48 (170 KB/s) - `/global_src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz' saved [291190/291190] > - > -This command should start to download the source archive. If it fails, > -we should check our network connection, proxy setup or if the given URL > -in use is correct. > - > -.. note:: Sometimes we do not know the content of all the other variables in > - the rule file. To get an idea what content a variable has, we can ask > - PTXdist about it: > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ ptxdist print FOO_URL > - http://www.foo.com/download/src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz > - > -The next step would be to extract the archive. But as PTXdist checks the > -MD5 sum in this case, this step will fail, because the ``FOO_MD5`` > -variable is still empty. Let’s fill it: > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ md5sum /global_src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz > - 9a09840ab775a139ebb00f57a587b447 > - > -This string must be assigned to the FOO_MD5 in our new ``foo.make`` > -rule file: > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - FOO_MD5 := 9a09840ab775a139ebb00f57a587b447 > - > -We are now prepared for the next step: > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ ptxdist extract foo > - > - ----------------------- > - target: foo.extract > - ----------------------- > - > - extract: archive=/global_src/foo-1.1.0.tar.gz > - extract: dest=/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target > - PATCHIN: packet=foo-1.1.0 > - PATCHIN: dir=/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0 > - PATCHIN: no patches for foo-1.1.0 available > - Fixing up /home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0/configure > - finished target foo.extract > - > -In this example we expect an autotoolized source package. E.g. to > -prepare the build, the archive comes with a ``configure`` script. This > -is the default case for PTXdist. So, there is no need to modify the rule > -file and we can simply run: > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ ptxdist prepare foo > - > - ----------------------- > - target: foo.prepare > - ----------------------- > - > - [...] > - > - checking build system type... i686-host-linux-gnu > - checking host system type... |ptxdistCompilerName| > - checking whether to enable maintainer-specific portions of Makefiles... no > - checking for a BSD-compatible install... /usr/bin/install -c > - checking whether build environment is sane... yes > - checking for a thread-safe mkdir -p... /bin/mkdir -p > - checking for gawk... gawk > - checking whether make sets $(MAKE)... yes > - checking for |ptxdistCompilerName|-strip... |ptxdistCompilerName|-strip > - checking for |ptxdistCompilerName|-gcc... |ptxdistCompilerName|-gcc > - checking for C compiler default output file name... a.out > - > - [...] > - > - configure: creating ./config.status > - config.status: creating Makefile > - config.status: creating ppa_protocol/Makefile > - config.status: creating config.h > - config.status: executing depfiles commands > - finished target foo.prepare > - > -At this stage things can fail: > - > -- A wrong or no MD5 sum was given > - > -- The ``configure`` script is not cross compile aware > - > -- The package depends on external components (libraries for example) > - > -If the ``configure`` script is not cross compile aware, we are out of > -luck. We must patch the source archive in this case to make it work. > -Refer to the section :ref:`configure_rebuild` on how to use > -PTXdist’s features to simplify this task. > -If the package depends on external components, these components might > -be already part of PTXdist. In this case we just have to add this > -dependency into the menu file and we are done. But if PTXdist cannot > -fulfill this dependency, we also must add it as a separate package > -first. > - > -If the *prepare* stage has finished successfully, the next step is to > -compile the package. > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ ptxdist compile foo > - > - ----------------------- > - target: foo.compile > - ----------------------- > - > - make[1]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > - make all-recursive > - make[2]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > - make[3]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > - > - [...] > - > - make[3]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > - make[2]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > - make[1]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > - finished target foo.compile > - > -At this stage things can fail: > - > -- The build system is not cross compile aware (it tries to execute just > - created target binaries for example) > - > -- The package depends on external components (libraries for example) > - not detected by ``configure`` > - > -- Sources are ignoring the endianness of some architectures or using > - header files from the build host system (from ``/usr/include`` for > - example) > - > -- The linker uses libraries from the build host system (from > - ``/usr/lib`` for example) by accident > - > -In all of these cases we must patch the sources to make them work. Refer > -to section :ref:`patching_packages` on how to use PTXdist’s > -features to simplify this task. > - > -In this example we expect the best case: everything went fine, even for > -cross compiling. So, we can continue with the next stage: *install* > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ ptxdist install foo > - > - ----------------------- > - target: foo.install > - ----------------------- > - > - make[1]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > - make[2]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > - make[3]: Entering directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > - test -z "/usr/bin" || /bin/mkdir -p "/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0/usr/bin" > - /usr/bin/install -c 'foo' '/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0/usr/bin/foo' > - make[3]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > - make[2]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > - make[1]: Leaving directory `/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0' > - finished target foo.install > - > - ---------------------------- > - target: foo.install.post > - ---------------------------- > - > - finished target foo.install.post > - > -This *install* stage does not install anything to the target root > -filesystem. It is mostly intended to install libraries and header files > -other programs should link against later on. > - > -The last stage – *targetinstall* – is the one that defines the package’s > -components to be forwarded to the target’s root filesystem. Due to the > -absence of a generic way, this is the task of the developer. So, at this > -point of time we must run our favourite editor again and modify our new > -rule file ``./rules/foo.make``. > - > -The skeleton for the *targetinstall* stage looks like this: > - > -.. code-block:: make > - > - # ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- > - # Target-Install > - # ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- > - > - $(STATEDIR)/foo.targetinstall: > - @$(call targetinfo) > - > - @$(call install_init, foo) > - @$(call install_fixup, foo,PACKAGE,foo) > - @$(call install_fixup, foo,PRIORITY,optional) > - @$(call install_fixup, foo,VERSION,$(FOO_VERSION)) > - @$(call install_fixup, foo,SECTION,base) > - @$(call install_fixup, foo,AUTHOR,"My Name <me@my-org.com>") > - @$(call install_fixup, foo,DEPENDS,) > - @$(call install_fixup, foo,DESCRIPTION,missing) > - > - @$(call install_copy, foo, 0, 0, 0755, $(FOO_DIR)/foobar, /dev/null) > - > - @$(call install_finish, foo) > - @$(call touch) > - > -The “header” of this stage defines some information IPKG needs. The > -important part that we must modify is the call to the ``install_copy`` > -macro (refer to section :ref:`reference_macros` for more details > -about this kind of macros). This call instructs PTXdist to include the > -given file (with UID, GID and permissions) into the IPKG, which means to > -install this file to the target’s root filesystem. > - > -From the previous *install* stage we know this package installs an > -executable called ``foo`` to location ``/usr/bin``. We can do the same > -for our target by changing the *install\_copy* line to: > - > -.. code-block:: none > - > - @$(call install_copy, foo, 0, 0, 0755, $(FOO_DIR)/foo, /usr/bin/foo) > - > -To check it, we just run: > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ ptxdist targetinstall foo > - > - ----------------------------- > - target: foo.targetinstall > - ----------------------------- > - > - install_init: preparing for image creation... > - install_init: @ARCH@ -> i386 ... done > - install_init: preinst not available > - install_init: postinst not available > - install_init: prerm not available > - install_init: postrm not available > - install_fixup: @PACKAGE@ -> foo ... done. > - install_fixup: @PRIORITY@ -> optional ... done. > - install_fixup: @VERSION@ -> 1.1.0 ... done. > - install_fixup: @SECTION@ -> base ... done. > - install_fixup: @AUTHOR@ -> "My Name <me\@my-org.com>" ... done. > - install_fixup: @DESCRIPTION@ -> missing ... done. > - install_copy: > - src=/home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0/foo > - dst=/usr/bin/foo > - owner=0 > - group=0 > - permissions=0755 > - xpkg_finish: collecting license (unknown) ... done. > - xpkg_finish: creating ipkg package ... done. > - finished target foo.targetinstall > - > - ---------------------------------- > - target: foo.targetinstall.post > - ---------------------------------- > - > - finished target foo.targetinstall.post > - > -After this command, the target’s root filesystem contains a file called > -``/usr/bin/foo`` owned by root, its group is also root and everyone has > -execution permissions, but only the user root has write permissions. > - > -One last task of this port is still open: A reasonable location for > -the new menu entry in PTXdist’s menu hierarchy. PTXdist arranges its > -menus on the meaning of each package. Is it a network related tool? Or > -a scripting language? Or a graphical application? > -Each of these global meanings has its own submenu, where we can add > -our new entry to. We just have to edit the head of our new menu file > -``./rules/foo.in`` to add it to a specific global menu. If our new > -package is a network related tool, the head of the menu file should > -look like: > - > -.. code-block:: kconfig > - > - ## SECTION=networking > - > -We can grep through the other menu files from the PTXdist main > -installation ``rules/`` directory to get an idea what section names are > -available: > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - rules/ $ find . -name \*.in | xargs grep "## SECTION" > - ./acpid.in:## SECTION=shell_and_console > - ./alsa-lib.in:## SECTION=system_libraries > - ./alsa-utils.in:## SECTION=multimedia_sound > - ./apache2.in:## SECTION=networking > - ./apache2_mod_python.in:## SECTION=networking > - [...] > - ./xkeyboard-config.in:## SECTION=multimedia_xorg_data > - ./xorg-app-xev.in:## SECTION=multimedia_xorg_app > - ./xorg-app-xrandr.in:## SECTION=multimedia_xorg_app > - ./host-eggdbus.in:## SECTION=hosttools_noprompt > - ./libssh2.in:## SECTION=networking > - > -Porting a new package to PTXdist is (almost) finished now. > - > -To check it right away, we simply run these two commands: > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ ptxdist clean foo > - rm -rf /home/jbe/my_new_prj/state/foo.* > - rm -rf /home/jbe/my_new_prj/packages/foo_* > - rm -rf /home/jbe/my_new_prj/build-target/foo-1.1.0 > - $ ptxdist targetinstall foo > - > - [...] > - > -.. important:: Discover somehow hidden dependencies with one more last check! > - > -Up to this point all the development of the new package was done in an already > -built BSP. Doing so sometimes somehow hidden dependencies cannot be seen: > -everything seems fine, the new package builds always successfully and the > -results are working on the target. > - > -So to check for this kind of dependencies there is still one more final check > -to do (even if its boring and takes time): > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ ptxdist clean > - [...] > - $ ptxdist targetinstall foo > - [...] > - > -This will re-start with a **clean** BSP and builds exactly the new package and > -its (known) dependencies. If this builds successfully as well we are really done > -with the new package. > - > -Some Notes about Licenses > -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > - > -The already mentioned rule variable ``*_LICENSE`` (e.g. ``FOO_LICENSE`` in our > -example) is very important and must be filled by the developer of the package. > -Many licenses bring in obligations using the corresponding package (*attribution* > -for example). To make life easier for everybody the license for a package must > -be provided. *SPDX* license identifiers unify the license names and are used > -in PTXdist to identify license types and obligations. > - > -If a package comes with more than one license, all of their SPDX identifiers > -must be listed and connected with the keyword ``AND``. If your package comes > -with GPL-2.0 and LGPL-2.1 licenses, the definition should look like this: > - > -.. code-block:: make > - > - FOO_LICENSE := GPL-2.0 AND LGPL-2.1 > - > -One specific obligation cannot be detected examining the SPDX license identifiers > -by PTXdist: *the license choice*. In this case all licenses of choice must be > -listed and connected by the keyword ``OR``. > - > -If, for example, your obligation is to select one of the licenses *GPL-2.0* **or** > -*GPL-3.0*, the ``*_LICENSE`` variable should look like this: > - > -.. code-block:: make > - > - FOO_LICENSE := GPL-2.0 OR GPL-3.0 > - > -SPDX License Identifiers > -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > - > -A list of SPDX license identifiers can be found here: > - > - https://spdx.org/licenses/ > - > -Help to Detect the Correct License > -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > - > -License identification isn't trivial. A help in doing so can be the following > -repository and its content. It contains a list of known licenses based on their > -SPDX identifier. The content is without formatting to simplify text search. > - > - https://github.com/spdx/license-list-data/tree/master/text > - > -Advanced Rule Files > -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > - > -The previous example on how to create a rule file sometimes works as > -shown above. But most of the time source archives are not that simple. > -In this section we want to give the user a more detailed selection how > -the package will be built. > - > -Adding Static Configure Parameters > -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > - > -The ``configure`` scripts of various source archives provide additional > -parameters to enable or disable features, or to configure them in a > -specific way. > - > -We assume the ``configure`` script of our ``foo`` example (refer to > -section :ref:`foo_example`) supports two additional parameters: > - > -- **--enable-debug**: Make the program more noisy. It’s disabled by > - default. > - > -- **--with-bar**: Also build the special executable **bar**. Building > - this executable is also disabled by default. > - > -We now want to forward these options to the ``configure`` script when it > -runs in the *prepare* stage. To do so, we must again open the rule file > -with our favourite editor and navigate to the *prepare* stage entry. > - > -PTXdist uses the variable ``FOO_CONF_OPT`` as the list of parameters to > -be given to ``configure``. > - > -Currently this variable is commented out and defined to: > - > -.. code-block:: make > - > - # FOO_CONF_OPT := $(CROSS_AUTOCONF_USR) > - > -The variable ``CROSS_AUTOCONF_USR`` is predefined by PTXdist and > -contains all basic parameters to instruct ``configure`` to prepare for a > -**cross** compile environment. > - > -To use the two additional mentioned ``configure`` parameters, we comment > -in this line and supplement this expression as follows: > - > -.. code-block:: make > - > - FOO_CONF_OPT := \ > - $(CROSS_AUTOCONF_USR) \ > - --enable-debug \ > - --with-bar > - > -.. note:: We recommend to use this format with each parameter on a line of > - its own. This format is easier to read and a diff shows more exactly any > - change. > - > -To do a fast check if this addition was successful, we run: > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ ptxdist print FOO_CONF_OPT > - --prefix=/usr --sysconfdir=/etc --host=|ptxdistCompilerName| --build=i686-host-linux-gnu --enable-debug --with-bar > - > -.. note:: It depends on the currently selected platform and its architecture > - what content this variable will have. The content shown above is an > - example for a target. > - > -Or re-build the package with the new settings: > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ ptxdist drop foo prepare > - $ ptxdist targetinstall foo > - > -Adding Dynamic Configure Parameters > -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > - > -Sometimes it makes sense to add this kind of parameters on demand only; > -especially a parameter like ``--enable-debug``. To let the user decide > -if this parameter is to be used or not, we must add a menu entry. So, > -let’s expand our menu. Here is its current content: > - > -.. code-block:: kconfig > - > - ## SECTION=project_specific > - > - config FOO > - tristate > - prompt "foo" > - help > - FIXME > - > -We’ll add two menu entries, one for each optional parameter we want to > -add on demand to the ``configure`` parameters: > - > -.. code-block:: kconfig > - > - ## SECTION=project_specific > - > - config FOO > - tristate > - prompt "foo" > - help > - FIXME > - > - if FOO > - config FOO_DEBUG > - bool > - prompt "add debug noise" > - > - config FOO_BAR > - bool > - prompt "build bar" > - > - endif > - > -.. important:: Always follow the rule to extend the base name by a suboption > - name as the trailing part of the variable name. This gives PTXdist the ability > - to detect a change in the package’s settings (via menuconfig) to force its > - rebuild on demand. > - > -To make usage of the new menu entries, we must check them in the rule > -file and add the correct parameters: > - > -.. code-block:: make > - > - # > - # autoconf > - # > - FOO_CONF_OPT := \ > - $(CROSS_AUTOCONF_USR) \ > - --$(call ptx/endis, PTXCONF_FOO_DEBUG)-debug \ > - --$(call ptx/wwo, PTXCONF_FOO_BAR)-bar > - > -.. important:: Please note the leading ``PTXCONF_`` for each define. While Kconfig is > - using ``FOO_BAR``, the rule file must use ``PTXCONF_FOO_BAR`` instead. > - > -.. note:: Refer :ref:`Rule File Macro Reference <param_macros>` for further > - details about these special kind of option macros (e.g. ``ptx/...``). > - > -It is a good practice to always add both settings, e.g. ``--disable-debug`` > -even if this is the default case. Sometimes ``configure`` tries to guess > -something and the binary result might differ depending on the build > -order. For example some kind of package would also build some X related > -tools, if X libraries are found. In this case it depends on the build > -order, if the X related tools are built or not. All the autocheck > -features are problematic here. So, if we do not want ``configure`` to > -guess its settings we **must disable everything we do not want**. > - > -To support this process, PTXdist supplies a helper script, located at > -``/path/to/ptxdist/scripts/configure-helper.py`` that compares the configure > -output with the settings from ``FOO_CONF_OPT``: > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ /opt/ptxdist-2017.06.0/scripts/configure-helper.py -p libsigrok > - --- rules/libsigrok.make > - +++ libsigrok-0.5.0 > - @@ -4,3 +4,74 @@ > - --libdir=/usr/lib > - --build=x86_64-host-linux-gnu > - --host=arm-v7a-linux-gnueabihf > - + --enable-warnings=min|max|fatal|no > - + --disable-largefile > - + --enable-all-drivers > - + --enable-agilent-dmm > - [...] > - + --enable-ruby > - + --enable-java > - + --without-libserialport > - + --without-libftdi > - + --without-libusb > - + --without-librevisa > - + --without-libgpib > - + --without-libieee1284 > - + --with-jni-include-path=DIR-LIST > - > -In this example, many configure options from libsigrok (marked with ``+``) > -are not yet present in ``LIBSIGROK_CONF_OPT`` and must be added, possibly also > -by providing more dynamic options in the package definition. > - > -If some parts of a package are built on demand only, they must also be > -installed on demand only. Besides the *prepare* stage, we also must > -modify our *targetinstall* stage: > - > -.. code-block:: make > - > - @$(call install_copy, foo, 0, 0, 0755, $(FOO_DIR)/foo, /usr/bin/foo) > - > - ifdef PTXCONF_FOO_BAR > - @$(call install_copy, foo, 0, 0, 0755, $(FOO_DIR)/bar, /usr/bin/bar) > - endif > - > - @$(call install_finish, foo) > - @$(call touch) > - > -Now we can play with our new menu entries and check if they are working > -as expected: > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ ptxdist menuconfig > - $ ptxdist targetinstall foo > - > -Whenever we change a *FOO* related menu entry, PTXdist should detect it > -and re-build the package when a new build is started. > - > -.. _external_dependencies: > - > -Managing External Compile Time Dependencies > -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > - > -While running the prepare stage, it could happen that it fails due to a > -missing external dependency. > - > -For example: > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - checking whether zlib exists....failed > - > -In this example, our new package depends on the compression library > -*zlib*. PTXdist comes with a target *zlib*. All we need to do in this > -case is to declare that our new package *foo* depends on *zlib*. This > -kind of dependency is managed in the menu file of our new package by > -simply adding the ``select ZLIB`` line. After this addition our menu > -file looks like: > - > -.. code-block:: kconfig > - > - ## SECTION=project_specific > - > - config FOO > - tristate > - select ZLIB > - prompt "foo" > - help > - FIXME > - > - if FOO > - config FOO_DEBUG > - bool > - prompt "add debug noise" > - > - config FOO_BAR > - bool > - prompt "build bar" > - > - endif > - > -PTXdist now builds the *zlib* first and our new package thereafter. > - > -Refer :ref:`external_dependencies_variants` for more specific dependency > -description. > - > -Managing External Compile Time Dependencies on Demand > -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > - > -It is good practice to add only those dependencies that are really > -required for the current configuration of the package. If the package > -provides the features *foo* and *bar* and its ``configure`` provides > -switches to enable/disable them independently, we can also add > -dependencies on demand. Let’s assume feature *foo* needs the compression > -library *libz* and *bar* needs the XML2 library *libxml2*. These > -libraries are only required at run-time if the corresponding feature is > -enabled. To add these dependencies on demand, the menu file looks like: > - > -.. code-block:: kconfig > - > - ## SECTION=project_specific > - > - config FOO > - tristate > - select ZLIB if FOO_FOO > - select LIBXML2 if FOO_BAR > - prompt "foo" > - help > - FIXME > - > - if FOO > - config FOO_DEBUG > - bool > - prompt "add debug noise" > - > - config FOO_FOO > - bool > - prompt "build foo" > - > - config FOO_BAR > - bool > - prompt "build bar" > - > - endif > - > -.. important:: Do not add these ``select`` statements to the corresponding menu entry. > - They must belong to the main menu entry of the package to ensure that > - the calculation of the dependencies between the packages is done in a > - correct manner. > - > -Managing External Runtime Dependencies > -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > - > -Some packages are building all of their components and also installing > -them into the target’s sysroot. But only their *targetinstall* stage > -decides which parts are copied to the root filesystem. So, compiling and > -linking of our package will work, because everything required is found > -in the target’s sysroot. > - > -In our example there is a hidden dependency to the math library > -``libm``. Our new package was built successfully, because the linker was > -able to link our binaries against the ``libm`` from the toolchain. But > -in this case the ``libm`` must also be available in the target’s root > -filesystem to fulfil the run-time dependency: We have to force PTXdist to > -install ``libm``. ``libm`` is part of the *glibc* package, but is not > -installed by default (to keep the root filesystem small). So, it **does > -not** help to select the ``GLIBC`` symbol, to get a ``libm`` at run-time. > - > -The correct solution here is to add a ``select LIBC_M`` to our menu > -file. With all the additions above it now looks like: > - > -.. code-block:: kconfig > - > - ## SECTION=project_specific > - > - config FOO > - tristate > - select ZLIB if FOO_FOO > - select LIBXML2 if FOO_BAR > - select LIBC_M > - prompt "foo" > - help > - FIXME > - > - if FOO > - config FOO_DEBUG > - bool > - prompt "add debug noise" > - > - config FOO_FOO > - bool > - prompt "build foo" > - > - config FOO_BAR > - bool > - prompt "build bar" > - > - endif > - > -.. note:: There are other packages around, that do not install everything by > - default. If our new package needs something special, we must take a look > - into the menu of the other package how to force the required components > - to be installed and add the corresponding ``selects`` to our own menu > - file. In this case it does not help to enable the required parts in our > - project configuration, because this has no effect on the build order! > - > -Managing Plain Makefile Packages > -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > - > -Many packages are still coming with a plain ``Makefile``. The user has > -to adapt it to make it work in a cross compile environment as well. > -PTXdist can also handle this kind of packages. We only have to specify > -a special *prepare* and *compile* stage. > - > -Such packages often have no special need for any kind of preparation. In > -this we must instruct PTXdist to do nothing in the *prepare* stage: > - > -.. code-block:: make > - > - FOO_CONF_TOOL := NO > - > -To compile the package, we can use ``make``\ ’s feature to overwrite > -variables used in the ``Makefile``. With this feature we can still use > -the original ``Makefile`` but with our own (cross compile) settings. > - > -Most of the time the generic compile rule can be used, only a few > -settings are required. For a well defined ``Makefile`` it is sufficient to > -set up the correct cross compile environment for the *compile* stage: > - > -.. code-block:: make > - > - FOO_MAKE_ENV := $(CROSS_ENV) > - > -``make`` will be called in this case with: > - > -``$(FOO_MAKE_ENV) $(MAKE) -C $(FOO_DIR) $(FOO_MAKE_OPT)`` > - > -So, in the rule file only the two variables ``FOO_MAKE_ENV`` and > -``FOO_MAKE_OPT`` must be set, to forward the required settings to the > -package’s buildsystem. If the package cannot be built in parallel, we > -can also add the ``FOO_MAKE_PAR := NO``. ``YES`` is the default. > - > -Managing CMake/QMake/Meson Packages > -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > - > -Building packages that use ``cmake``, ``qmake`` or ``meson`` is much like > -building packages with an autotools based buildsystem. We need to specify > -the configuration tool: > - > -.. code-block:: make > - > - FOO_CONF_TOOL := cmake > - > -or > - > -.. code-block:: make > - > - FOO_CONF_TOOL := qmake > - > -or respectively > - > -.. code-block:: make > - > - FOO_CONF_TOOL := meson > - > -And provide the correct configuration options. The syntax is different so > -PTXdist provides additional macros to simplify configurable features. > -For ``cmake`` the configuration options typically look like this: > - > -.. code-block:: make > - > - FOO_CONF_OPT := \ > - $(CROSS_CMAKE_USR) \ > - -DBUILD_TESTS:BOOL=OFF \ > - -DENABLE_BAR:BOOL=$(call ptx/onoff, PTXCONF_FOO_BAR) > - > -For ``qmake`` the configuration options typically look like this: > - > -.. code-block:: make > - > - FOO_CONF_OPT := \ > - $(CROSS_QMAKE_OPT) \ > - PREFIX=/usr > - > -And for ``meson`` the configuration options typically look like this: > - > -.. code-block:: make > - > - FOO_CONF_OPT := \ > - $(CROSS_MESON_USR) \ > - -Dbar=$(call ptx/truefalse,PTXCONF_FOO_BAR) > - > -Please note that currently only host and target ``cmake``\/``meson`` packages > -and only target ``qmake`` packages are supported. > - > -Managing Python Packages > -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > - > -As with any other package, the correct configuration tool must be selected > -for Python packages: > - > -.. code-block:: make > - > - FOO_CONF_TOOL := python > - > -.. note:: For Python3 packages the value must be ``python3``. > - > -No Makefiles are used when building Python packages so the usual ``make`` > -and ``make install`` for the *compile* and *install* stages cannot be used. > -PTXdist will call ``python setup.py build`` and ``python setup.py install`` > -instead. > - > -.. note:: *FOO* is still the name of our example package. It must be > - replaced by the real package name. > - > - > -.. _patching_packages: > - > -Patching Packages > -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > - > -There can be various reasons why a package must be patched: > - > -- Package is broken for cross compile environments > - > -- Package is broken within a specific feature > - > -- Package is vulnerable and needs some fixes > - > -- or anything else (this case is the most common one) > - > -Ideally, those problems should be addressed in the original project, > -so any patches you add to your BSP or to PTXdist should also be submitted upstream. > -The upstream project can often provide better feedback, they can integrate your > -patch into a new release, and also maintain your changes as part of the project. > -This way we make sure that all advantages of the open source idea work for us; > -and your patch can be removed again later when a new release of the project is > -integrated into your BSP or into PTXdist. > - > -PTXdist handles patching automatically. > -After extracting the archive of a package, PTXdist checks for the existence of > -a patch directory named like its ``<PKG>_PATCHES`` variable, or, if this variable > -is not set, like its ``<PKG>`` variable. > -The patch directory is then searched in all locations listed by the > -``PTXDIST_PATH_PATCHES`` variable, and the first one found is used. > -Take an exemplary package ``foo`` with version ``1.1.0``: > -The variable ``FOO`` will have the value ``foo-1.1.0``, so PTXdist will look for > -a patch directory named ``foo-1.1.0`` in the following locations: > - > -#. the current layer: > - > - a. project (``./patches/foo-1.1.0``) > - b. platform (``./configs/|ptxdistPlatformConfigDir|/patches/foo-1.1.0``) > - > -#. any :ref:`base layers <layers-in-ptxdist>`, > - applying the same search order as above for each layer recursively > - > -#. ptxdist (``<ptxdist/installation/path>/patches/foo-1.1.0``) > - > -The patches from the first location found are used. Note: Due to this > -search order, a PTXdist project can replace global patches from the > -PTXdist installation. This can be useful if a project sticks to a > -specific PTXdist revision but fixes from a more recent revision of > -PTXdist should be used. > - > -PTXdist uses the utilities *git*, *patch* or *quilt* to work with > -patches or patch series. We recommend *git*, as it can manage patch > -series in a very easy way. > - > -Creating a Patch Series for a Package > -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > - > -To create a patch series for the first time, we can run the following > -steps. We are still using our *foo-1.1.0* example package here: > - > -Using Quilt > -""""""""""" > - > -We create a special directory for the patch series in the local project > -directory: > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ mkdir -p patches/foo-1.1.0 > - > -PTXdist expects a ``series`` file in the patch directory and at least > -one patch. Otherwise it fails. Due to the fact that we do not have any > -patch content yet, we’ll start with a dummy entry in the ``series`` file > -and an empty ``patch`` file. > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ touch patches/foo-1.1.0/dummy > - $ echo dummy > patches/foo-1.1.0/series > - > -Next is to extract the package (if already done, we must remove it > -first): > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ ptxdist extract foo > - > -This will extract the archive and create a symbolic link in the build > -directory pointing to our local patch directory. Working this way will > -ensure that we do not lose our created patches if we enter > -``ptxdist clean foo`` by accident. In our case the patches are still > -present in ``patches/foo-1.1.0`` and can be used the next time we > -extract the package again. > - > -All we have to do now is to do the modification we need to make the > -package work. We change into the build directory and use quilt_ to > -create new patches, add files to respective patches, modify these files > -and refresh the patches to save our changes. > -See the *quilt* documentation (``man 1 quilt``) for more information. > - > -.. note:: For patches that are intended for PTXdist upstream use the git > - workflow described below to get proper patch headers. > - > -.. _quilt: http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/quilt > - > -Using Git > -""""""""" > - > -Create the patch directory like above for *quilt*, > -but only add an empty series file: > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ mkdir -p patches/foo-1.1.0 > - $ touch patches/foo-1.1.0/series > - > -Then extract the package with an additional command line switch: > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ ptxdist --git extract foo > - > -The empty series file makes PTXdist create a Git repository in the > -respective package build directory, > -and import the package source as the first commit. > - > -.. note:: Optionally, you can enable the setting *Developer Options → > - use git to apply patches* in `ptxdist setup` to get this behaviour > - as a default for every package. > - However, note that this setting is meant for development only, and can lead > - to failures – some packages try to determine if they are being compiled from > - a Git source tree, and behave differently in that case. > - > -Then you can change into the package build directory > -(``platform-<name>/build-target/foo-1.1.0``), > -patch the required source files, > -and make Git commits on the way. > -The Git history should now look something like this: > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ git log --oneline --decorate > - * df343e821851 (HEAD -> master) Makefile: don't build the tests > - * 65a360c2bd60 strfry.c: frobnicate the excusator > - * fdc315f6844c (tag: foobar-1.1.0, tag: base) initial commit > - > -Finally, call ``git ptx-patches`` to transform those Git commits into the patch > -series in the ``patches/foo-1.1.0`` folder. > -This way they don't get lost when cleaning the package. > - > -.. note:: PTXdist will only create a Git repository for packages with > - patches. To use Git to generate the first patch, create an empty series > - file ``patches/foobar-1.1.0/series`` before extracting the packages. This > - will tell PTXdist to use Git anyways and ``git ptx-patches`` will put the > - patches there. > - > -Both approaches (Git and quilt) are not suitable for modifying files > -that are autogenerated in autotools-based buildsystems. > -Refer to the section :ref:`configure_rebuild` on how PTXdist can > -handle this special task. > - > -Adding More Patches to a Package > -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > - > -If we want to add more patches to an already patched package, we can use > -nearly the same way as creating patches for the first time. But if the > -patch series comes from the PTXdist main installation, we do not have > -write permissions to these directories (do NEVER work on the main > -installation directories, NEVER, NEVER, NEVER). Due to the search order > -in which PTXdist searches for patches for a specific package, we can > -copy the global patch series to our local project directory. Now we have > -the permissions to add more patches or modify the existing ones. Also > -*quilt* and *git* are our friends here to manage the patch series. > - > -If we think that our new patches are valuable also for others, or they > -fix an error, it could be a good idea to send these patches to PTXdist > -mainline, and to the upstream project too. > - > - > -.. _configure_rebuild: > - > -Modifying Autotoolized Packages > -^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > - > -Autotoolized packages are very picky when automatically generated files > -get patched. The patch order is very important in this case and > -sometimes it even fails and nobody knows why. > - > -To improve a package’s autotools-based build system, PTXdist comes with > -its own project local autotools to regenerate the autotools template > -files, instead of patching them. With this feature, only the template > -files must be patched, the required ``configure`` script and the > -``Makefile.in`` files are regenerated in the final stages of the > -*prepare* step. > - > -This feature works like the regular patching mechanism. The only > -difference is the additional ``autogen.sh`` file in the patch directory. > -If it exists and has execution permissions, it will be called after the > -package was patched (while the *extract* stage is running). > - > -Its content depends on developer needs; for the most simple case the > -content can be: > - > -.. code-block:: bash > - > - #!/bin/bash > - > - aclocal $ACLOCAL_FLAGS > - > - libtoolize \ > - --force \ > - --copy > - > - autoreconf \ > - --force \ > - --install \ > - --warnings=cross \ > - --warnings=syntax \ > - --warnings=obsolete \ > - --warnings=unsupported > - > -.. note:: In this way not yet autotoolized package can be autotoolized. We > - just have to add the common autotool template files (``configure.ac`` > - and ``Makefile.am`` for example) via a patch series to the package > - source and the ``autogen.sh`` to the patch directory. > - > -.. _adding_files: > - > -Adding Binary Only Files > ------------------------- > - > -Sometimes a few binary files have to be added into the root filesystem. > -Or - to be more precise - some files, that do not need to be built in > -any way. > - > -On the other hand, sometimes files should be included that are not > -covered by any open source license and so, should not be shipped in the > -source code format. > - > -Add Binary Files File by File > -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > - > -Doing to on a file by file base can happen by just using the ``install_copy`` > -macro in the *targetinstall* stage in our own customized rules file. > - > -.. code-block:: none > - > - @$(call install_copy, binary_example, 0, 0, 0644, \ > - </path/to/some/file/>ptx_logo.png, \ > - /example/ptx_logo.png) > - > -It copies the file ``ptx_logo.png`` from some location to target’s root > -filesystem. Refer :ref:`install_copy` for further information about using the > -``install_copy`` macro. > - > -The disadvantage of this method is: if we want to install more than one > -file, we need one call to the ``install_copy`` macro per file. This is > -even harder if not only a set of files is to be installed, but a whole > -directory tree with files instead. > - > -Add Binary Files via an Archive > -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > - > -If a whole tree of files is to be installed, working with a *tar* based > -archive could make life easier. In this case the archive itself provides > -all the required information the files are needing to be installed in a > -correct manner: > - > -- the file itself and its name > - > -- the directory structure and the final location of every file in this > - structure > - > -- user and group ID on a per file base > - > -.. code-block:: none > - > - @$(call install_archive, binary_example, -, -, \ > - </path/to/an/>archive.tgz, /) > - > -Refer :ref:`install_archive` for further information about using the > -``install_archive`` macro. > - > -Using an archive can be useful to install parts of the root filesystem > -that are not covered by any open source license. Its possible to ship > -the binaries within the regular BSP, without the need for their sources. > -However it is possible for the customer to re-create everything required > -from the BSP to get their target up and running again. > - > -Another use case for the archive method could be the support for > -different development teams. One team provides a software component in > -the archive format, the other team does not need to build it but can use > -it in the same way than every other software component. > - > -Creating a Rules File > -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > - > -Let PTXdist create one for us. > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ ptxdist newpackage file > - > - ptxdist: creating a new 'file' package: > - > - ptxdist: enter package name.......: my_binfiles > - ptxdist: enter version number.....: 1 > - ptxdist: enter package author.....: My Name <me@my-org.com> > - ptxdist: enter package section....: rootfs > - > -Now two new files are present in the BSP: > - > -#. ``rules/my_binfiles.in`` The template for the menu > - > -#. ``rules/my_binfiles.make`` The rules template > - > -Both files now must be customized to meet our requirements. Due to the > -answer *rootfs* to the “``enter package section``” question, we will > -find the new menu entry in: > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - Root Filesystem ---> > - < > my_binfiles (NEW) > - > -Enabling this new entry will also run our stages in > -``rules/my_binfiles.make`` the next time we enter: > - > -.. code-block:: text > - > - $ ptxdist go > - > -Creating New Package Templates > ------------------------------- > - > -For larger projects it can be convenient to have project specific package > -templates. This can be achieved by either modifying existing templates or > -by creating completely new templates. > - > -Modifying a Template > -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > - > -A template can be modified by providing new input files. This is easier > -than creating a new template but does not allow to specify new variables to > -substitute in the input files. > - > -PTXdist looks for template files the same way it looks for rules files. The > -only difference is, that it searches in the ``templates/`` subdirectory. > -So a modified ``./rules/templates/template-target-make`` can be used to > -tweak the ``target`` template. > - > -Creating a New Template > -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > - > -For a completely new template, some bash scripting is required. All shell > -code must be placed in a file named like this: > -``./scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_*.sh``. > - > -The minimum requirement for a new template is: > -- a shell function that creates the new package > -- registering the new template > - > -.. code-block:: sh > - > - ptxd_template_new_mypkg() { > - # create the package here > - } > - export -f ptxd_template_new_mypkg > - ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="mypkg" > - ptxd_template_help_list[${#ptxd_template_help_list[@]}]="create awesome mypkg package" > - > -PTXdist provides several helper functions to simplify the template. > -Using those functions, the package creation process is split into two > -parts: > - > -- query the user for input and export variables. > -- create the new package files from the template source files by > - substituting all instances of ``@<variable>@`` with the value of the > - corresponding variable. > - > -A simple template function could look like this: > - > -.. code-block:: sh > - > - ptxd_template_new_mypkg() { > - ptxd_template_read_basic && > - ptxd_template_read "enter download section" DL_SECTION "foobar" > - ptxd_template_read_author && > - export section="local_${dlsection}" && > - ptxd_template_write_rules > - } > - > -This template requires ``rules/templates/template-mypkg-make`` and > -``rules/templates/template-mypkg-in`` as source files. They could be > -derived from the ``target`` template with a simple modification: > - > -.. code-block:: make > - > - @PACKAGE@_SUFFIX := tar.xz > - @PACKAGE@_URL := http://dl.my-company.local/downloads/@DL_SECTION@/$(@PACKAGE@).$(@PACKAGE@_SUFFIX) > - > -The helper functions that are used in the example above are defined in > -``scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_template.sh`` in the PTXdist source tree. > - > -The template is a normal shell function. Arbitrary things can be done here > -to create the new package. The helper functions are just the most > -convenient way to crate simple templates. It is also possible to create > -more files. For examples, the builtin ``genimage`` template creates a extra > -config file for the new package. > - > -.. _layers-in-ptxdist: > - > -Layers in PTXdist > ------------------ > - > -For better maintenance or other reasons, a PTXdist project can be split > -into multiple layers. Each layer has exactly the same directory hierarchy > -as described in :ref:`directory_hierarchy` and other chapters. > - > -All layers are explicitly stacked in the filesystem. The top layer is the > -workspace of the PTXdist project. Any ``selected_*`` links and the platform > -build directory are created here. The layer below is defined by the > -subdirectory or symlink named ``base/``. More can be stacked the same > -way, so ``base/base/`` is the third layer and so on. > -In many ways, PTXdist itself can be considered as the bottom layer. This is > -either implicit or explicit with one last ``base/`` symlink. > - > -A project can overwrite files provided by PTXdist in many different ways, > -e.g. rule files or files installed with :ref:`install_alternative` etc. > -This concept expands naturally to layers. Each layer can overwrite files > -provided by lower layers in the exact same way. Any files are always > -searched for in a strict layer by layer order. > - > -Writing Layer Aware Rules > -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > - > -For the most part, package rules work just as expected when multiple layers > -are used. Any layer specific handling is done implicitly by PTXdist. > -However, there are a few things that need special handling. > - > -The variables :ref:`PTXDIST_WORKSPACE<ptxdist_workspace>` and > -:ref:`PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR`<ptxdist_platformconfigdir>` always refer > -to the directories in the top layer. These variables might be used in rules > -files like this: > - > -.. code-block:: make > - > - MY_KERNEL_CONFIG := $(PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR)/kernelconfig.special > - > -If the referenced file is in any layer but the top one then it will not > -be found. To handle use-cases like this, the macros :ref:`in_path` and > -:ref:`in_platformconfigdir` can be used: > - > -.. code-block:: make > - > - MY_KERNEL_CONFIG := $(call ptx/in-platformconfigdir, kernelconfig.special) > - > -This way, the layers are searched top to bottom until the config file is > -found. > - > -PTXdist Config Files with Multiple Layers > -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > - > -In many cases a layer may want to modify the **ptxconfig** by enabling or > -disabling some options. Any changes must be propagated through the whole > -layer stack. > - > -The features and workflow described here apply to the **ptxconfig**, the > -**platformconfig** and any **collectionconfig** used in the project. > - > -To do this, PTXdist stores a delta config to the layer below and a full > -config file in each layer. If the two files are missing then the config is > -unchanged. The bottom layer has only the config file and no delta. > - > -At runtime, PTXdist will always use the full config file in the top layer > -where the config exists. Before doing so, it will ensure that the config is > -consistent across all layers. This means that, for any layer that contains a > -delta config, the full config file of the layer below has not changed since > -the delta config was last updated. If any inconsistency is detected, > -PTXdist will abort. > - > -For any command that modifies the config file, except ``oldconfig``, > -PTXdist will use kconfig implicitly on all layers to check if the config > -for this layer is up to date. This is a stricter check than the consistency > -validation. For example, if a new package was added to a layer without > -updating the **ptxconfig** then this will be detected and PTXdist will > -abort. If all other layers are up to date, then PTXdist will use the delta > -config of the top layer, apply it to the full config of the layer below > -and execute the specified command with the resulting config file. > - > -.. note:: If the config file does not exist yet on the top layer, then it > - will be created if changes to the config are made. Similarly the config > - will be deleted if the delta is empty after the changes. In either case > - it may be necessary to update any ``selected_*`` link to point to the > - correct config. > - > -If PTXdist detects an inconsistency or an out of date config file then it > -must be updated before they can be used. This can be done by using the > -``oldconfig`` command. In this special case, PTXdist will iterate from the > -bottom to the top layer and run ``oldconfig`` for each of them. It will > -use the delta config applied to the full config of the layer below at each > -step. This means that it's possible to enable or disable a option in the > -bottom layer and ``oldconfig`` will propagate this change to all other > -layers. > - > -Packages with kconfig Based Config Files > -~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > - > -For packages such as the Linux kernel that have kconfig based config files, > -a lot of the infrastructure to handle config files and deltas across > -multiple layers can be reused. Consistency validation is done implicitly > -and ``menuconfig`` and other kconfig commands will use config files and > -deltas as expected. > - > -It's not possible to implicitly run ``oldconfig`` on other layers (this may > -require a different source tree for the packages), so any inconsistencies > -must be resolved manually by running ``oldconfig`` explicitly on each > -layer. > - > -The make macros that provide these features are currently used by the > -barebox and kernel packages and templates. > +.. toctree:: > + :glob: > + :maxdepth: 2 > + > + dev_dir_hierarchy > + dev_add_new_pkgs > + dev_add_bin_only_files > + dev_create_new_pkg_templates > + dev_layers_in_ptxdist _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 4/6] doc: move code signing docs from scripts/ into doc/ 2020-06-17 14:31 [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 0/6] Add code-signing-provider template, add code signing docs Bastian Krause ` (2 preceding siblings ...) 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 3/6] doc: dev_manual: split up into multiple files Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-17 14:31 ` Bastian Krause 2020-06-19 22:04 ` [ptxdist] [APPLIED] " Michael Olbrich 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 5/6] doc: dev_code_signing: rework and extend code signing section Bastian Krause 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 6/6] doc: introduce ref_code_signing_helpers Bastian Krause 5 siblings, 1 reply; 24+ messages in thread From: Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-17 14:31 UTC (permalink / raw) To: ptxdist; +Cc: Bastian Krause, Roland Hieber Signed-off-by: Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> Reviewed-by: Roland Hieber <rhi@pengutronix.de> Tested-by: Ladislav Michl <ladis@linux-mips.org> --- No changes since (implicit) v1. --- doc/dev_code_signing.rst | 36 ++++++++++++++++++++++++++++ doc/dev_manual.rst | 1 + scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_code_signing.sh | 32 ++----------------------- 3 files changed, 39 insertions(+), 30 deletions(-) create mode 100644 doc/dev_code_signing.rst diff --git a/doc/dev_code_signing.rst b/doc/dev_code_signing.rst new file mode 100644 index 000000000..de0087f8b --- /dev/null +++ b/doc/dev_code_signing.rst @@ -0,0 +1,36 @@ +.. _code_signing: + +Code Signing +------------ + +This is an overview over the ptxdist signing infrastructure. +ptxdist uses PKCS#11 internally for providing access to keys and certificates. +Packages that wish to sign something should implement a PKCS#11 interface. + +As PKCS#11 URIs usually differ between different usecases (release vs. +development) the URIs normally are not hardcoded in the package configuration. +Instead, ptxdist has the idea of "roles" which are string identifiers used to +access a single private/public key pair and a certificate. + +ptxdist supports Hardware Security Modules (HSM). +In case a HSM is not present or shall not be used SoftHSM is used internally to +transparently provide the same API internally. + +For each role a PKCS#11 URI must be known by ptxdist. +In case of a HSM the keys and certificates are stored in the HSM, but ptxdist +needs to know the PKCS#11 URI to access the keys. +This is done in ptxdist rule files calling cs_set_uri <role> <uri>. +For SoftHSM the URI is generated internally by ptxdist, but instead the +keys/certificates for each role have have to be imported. +This is done with the cs_import_* functions below. + +During each invocation of ptxdist exactly one key provider is active. +The code signing provider can be chosen with the PTXCONF_CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER +variable. +A code signing provider is a package resposible for providing the role <-> +PKCS#11 URI relationships in case a HSM is used or for providing the key +material in case SoftHSM is used. + +A package which wants to sign something or which needs access to keys has to +select CODE_SIGNING. +This makes sure the keys are ready when the package is being built. diff --git a/doc/dev_manual.rst b/doc/dev_manual.rst index 47a77a9be..03a05a661 100644 --- a/doc/dev_manual.rst +++ b/doc/dev_manual.rst @@ -14,3 +14,4 @@ This chapter shows all (or most) of the details of how PTXdist works. dev_add_bin_only_files dev_create_new_pkg_templates dev_layers_in_ptxdist + dev_code_signing diff --git a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_code_signing.sh b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_code_signing.sh index a7779f821..65ce62dd0 100644 --- a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_code_signing.sh +++ b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_code_signing.sh @@ -7,36 +7,8 @@ # # -# This is an overview over the ptxdist signing infrastructure. ptxdist -# uses PKCS#11 internally for providing access to keys and certificates. -# Packages that wish to sign something should implement a PKCS#11 interface. -# -# As PKCS#11 URIs usually differ between different usecases (release vs. -# development) the URIs normally are not hardcoded in the package -# configuration. Instead, ptxdist has the idea of "roles" which are string -# identifiers used to access a single private/public key pair and a -# certificate. -# -# ptxdist supports Hardware Security Modules (HSM). In case a HSM is not -# present or shall not be used SoftHSM is used internally to transparently -# provide the same API internally. -# -# For each role a PKCS#11 URI must be known by ptxdist. In case of a HSM -# the keys and certificates are stored in the HSM, but ptxdist needs to know -# the PKCS#11 URI to access the keys. This is done in ptxdist rule files -# calling cs_set_uri <role> <uri>. For SoftHSM the URI is generated internally -# by ptxdist, but instead the keys/certificates for each role have have to -# be imported. This is done with the cs_import_* functions below. -# -# During each invocation of ptxdist exactly one key provider is active. The -# code signing provider can be chosen with the PTXCONF_CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER -# variable. A code signing provider is a package resposible for providing -# the role <-> PKCS#11 URI relationships in case a HSM is used or for providing -# the key material in case SoftHSM is used. -# -# A package which wants to sign something or which needs access to keys has -# to select CODE_SIGNING. This makes sure the keys are ready when the package -# is being built. +# See doc/dev_code_signing.rst for documentation about PTXdist's code signing +# infrastructure. # cs_check_env() { -- 2.27.0 _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* Re: [ptxdist] [APPLIED] doc: move code signing docs from scripts/ into doc/ 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 4/6] doc: move code signing docs from scripts/ into doc/ Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-19 22:04 ` Michael Olbrich 0 siblings, 0 replies; 24+ messages in thread From: Michael Olbrich @ 2020-06-19 22:04 UTC (permalink / raw) To: ptxdist; +Cc: Bastian Krause Thanks, applied as 33c4b37cab1ba5ae924e073d65ab0cbfa2b7c922. Michael [sent from post-receive hook] On Sat, 20 Jun 2020 00:04:08 +0200, Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> wrote: > Signed-off-by: Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> > Reviewed-by: Roland Hieber <rhi@pengutronix.de> > Tested-by: Ladislav Michl <ladis@linux-mips.org> > Message-Id: <20200617143125.23999-5-bst@pengutronix.de> > Signed-off-by: Michael Olbrich <m.olbrich@pengutronix.de> > > diff --git a/doc/dev_code_signing.rst b/doc/dev_code_signing.rst > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000000..de0087f8b36a > --- /dev/null > +++ b/doc/dev_code_signing.rst > @@ -0,0 +1,36 @@ > +.. _code_signing: > + > +Code Signing > +------------ > + > +This is an overview over the ptxdist signing infrastructure. > +ptxdist uses PKCS#11 internally for providing access to keys and certificates. > +Packages that wish to sign something should implement a PKCS#11 interface. > + > +As PKCS#11 URIs usually differ between different usecases (release vs. > +development) the URIs normally are not hardcoded in the package configuration. > +Instead, ptxdist has the idea of "roles" which are string identifiers used to > +access a single private/public key pair and a certificate. > + > +ptxdist supports Hardware Security Modules (HSM). > +In case a HSM is not present or shall not be used SoftHSM is used internally to > +transparently provide the same API internally. > + > +For each role a PKCS#11 URI must be known by ptxdist. > +In case of a HSM the keys and certificates are stored in the HSM, but ptxdist > +needs to know the PKCS#11 URI to access the keys. > +This is done in ptxdist rule files calling cs_set_uri <role> <uri>. > +For SoftHSM the URI is generated internally by ptxdist, but instead the > +keys/certificates for each role have have to be imported. > +This is done with the cs_import_* functions below. > + > +During each invocation of ptxdist exactly one key provider is active. > +The code signing provider can be chosen with the PTXCONF_CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER > +variable. > +A code signing provider is a package resposible for providing the role <-> > +PKCS#11 URI relationships in case a HSM is used or for providing the key > +material in case SoftHSM is used. > + > +A package which wants to sign something or which needs access to keys has to > +select CODE_SIGNING. > +This makes sure the keys are ready when the package is being built. > diff --git a/doc/dev_manual.rst b/doc/dev_manual.rst > index 47a77a9be62f..03a05a661a97 100644 > --- a/doc/dev_manual.rst > +++ b/doc/dev_manual.rst > @@ -14,3 +14,4 @@ This chapter shows all (or most) of the details of how PTXdist works. > dev_add_bin_only_files > dev_create_new_pkg_templates > dev_layers_in_ptxdist > + dev_code_signing > diff --git a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_code_signing.sh b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_code_signing.sh > index a7779f8212c6..65ce62dd0a32 100644 > --- a/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_code_signing.sh > +++ b/scripts/lib/ptxd_lib_code_signing.sh > @@ -7,36 +7,8 @@ > # > > # > -# This is an overview over the ptxdist signing infrastructure. ptxdist > -# uses PKCS#11 internally for providing access to keys and certificates. > -# Packages that wish to sign something should implement a PKCS#11 interface. > -# > -# As PKCS#11 URIs usually differ between different usecases (release vs. > -# development) the URIs normally are not hardcoded in the package > -# configuration. Instead, ptxdist has the idea of "roles" which are string > -# identifiers used to access a single private/public key pair and a > -# certificate. > -# > -# ptxdist supports Hardware Security Modules (HSM). In case a HSM is not > -# present or shall not be used SoftHSM is used internally to transparently > -# provide the same API internally. > -# > -# For each role a PKCS#11 URI must be known by ptxdist. In case of a HSM > -# the keys and certificates are stored in the HSM, but ptxdist needs to know > -# the PKCS#11 URI to access the keys. This is done in ptxdist rule files > -# calling cs_set_uri <role> <uri>. For SoftHSM the URI is generated internally > -# by ptxdist, but instead the keys/certificates for each role have have to > -# be imported. This is done with the cs_import_* functions below. > -# > -# During each invocation of ptxdist exactly one key provider is active. The > -# code signing provider can be chosen with the PTXCONF_CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER > -# variable. A code signing provider is a package resposible for providing > -# the role <-> PKCS#11 URI relationships in case a HSM is used or for providing > -# the key material in case SoftHSM is used. > -# > -# A package which wants to sign something or which needs access to keys has > -# to select CODE_SIGNING. This makes sure the keys are ready when the package > -# is being built. > +# See doc/dev_code_signing.rst for documentation about PTXdist's code signing > +# infrastructure. > # > > cs_check_env() { _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 5/6] doc: dev_code_signing: rework and extend code signing section 2020-06-17 14:31 [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 0/6] Add code-signing-provider template, add code signing docs Bastian Krause ` (3 preceding siblings ...) 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 4/6] doc: move code signing docs from scripts/ into doc/ Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-17 14:31 ` Bastian Krause 2020-06-19 22:04 ` [ptxdist] [APPLIED] " Michael Olbrich 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 6/6] doc: introduce ref_code_signing_helpers Bastian Krause 5 siblings, 1 reply; 24+ messages in thread From: Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-17 14:31 UTC (permalink / raw) To: ptxdist; +Cc: Bastian Krause, Roland Hieber Signed-off-by: Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> Reviewed-by: Roland Hieber <rhi@pengutronix.de> Tested-by: Ladislav Michl <ladis@linux-mips.org> --- Changes since v2: - adjust section "Creating Custom Code Signing Providers" to updated code signing provider templates Changes since (implicit) v1: - add hyperlink target to code signing consumers to allow references in a later commit --- doc/dev_code_signing.rst | 148 +++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++------ 1 file changed, 125 insertions(+), 23 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/dev_code_signing.rst b/doc/dev_code_signing.rst index de0087f8b..fbebb6b52 100644 --- a/doc/dev_code_signing.rst +++ b/doc/dev_code_signing.rst @@ -3,34 +3,136 @@ Code Signing ------------ -This is an overview over the ptxdist signing infrastructure. -ptxdist uses PKCS#11 internally for providing access to keys and certificates. -Packages that wish to sign something should implement a PKCS#11 interface. +In order to make sure an artifact was created by a known authority and was not +altered later, digital signatures play a key role when building firmware +images. +This is also essential when a verified boot chain is established, e.g. via +*High Assurance Boot* (HAB), signed FIT images, and a verified root file +system. + +PTXdist uses `PKCS#11 <pkcs11-doc_>`_ internally to provide access to keys and +certificates, therefore code signing consumers should implement a PKCS#11 +interface to make use of PTXdist's code signing infrastructure. As PKCS#11 URIs usually differ between different usecases (release vs. -development) the URIs normally are not hardcoded in the package configuration. -Instead, ptxdist has the idea of "roles" which are string identifiers used to +development) the URIs are usually not hardcoded in the package configuration. +Instead, PTXdist has the idea of **roles** which are string identifiers used to access a single private/public key pair and a certificate. -ptxdist supports Hardware Security Modules (HSM). -In case a HSM is not present or shall not be used SoftHSM is used internally to -transparently provide the same API internally. +Finally, one or several **code signing providers** supply the mapping from +roles to the respective key material or even provide it themselves for +development. + +PTXdist supports *Hardware Security Modules* (HSM). +In case an HSM is not present or shall not be used, PTXdist can emulate it +using `SoftHSM <softhsm_>`_, while still transparently providing the same API +to code signing consumers. + +.. _pkcs11-doc: https://www.cryptsoft.com/pkcs11doc/ +.. _softhsm: https://www.opendnssec.org/softhsm/ + +.. _code_signing_providers: -For each role a PKCS#11 URI must be known by ptxdist. -In case of a HSM the keys and certificates are stored in the HSM, but ptxdist +Code Signing Providers +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ + +For each role a PKCS#11 URI must be known by PTXdist. +In case of an HSM the keys and certificates are stored in the HSM, but PTXdist needs to know the PKCS#11 URI to access the keys. -This is done in ptxdist rule files calling cs_set_uri <role> <uri>. -For SoftHSM the URI is generated internally by ptxdist, but instead the -keys/certificates for each role have have to be imported. -This is done with the cs_import_* functions below. - -During each invocation of ptxdist exactly one key provider is active. -The code signing provider can be chosen with the PTXCONF_CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER -variable. -A code signing provider is a package resposible for providing the role <-> -PKCS#11 URI relationships in case a HSM is used or for providing the key +For SoftHSM the URI is generated internally by PTXdist, but instead the +keys/certificates for each role have to be imported by the code signing +provider into the SoftHSM. + +A code signing provider is a package responsible for providing the role ↔ +PKCS#11 URI relationships in case an HSM is used, or for providing the key material in case SoftHSM is used. -A package which wants to sign something or which needs access to keys has to -select CODE_SIGNING. -This makes sure the keys are ready when the package is being built. +When ``PTXCONF_CODE_SIGNING`` is enabled exactly one code signing provider is +active during each invocation of PTXdist. + +PTXdist comes equipped with a development code signing provider "devel" +implemented via the package ``host-ptx-code-signing-dev``. +It imports publicly available development keys for each role into the SoftHSM. + +.. important:: The ``host-ptx-code-signing-dev`` code signing provider can be + used to sign artifacts for development purposes, but **must not** be used for + production. + +Creating Custom Code Signing Providers +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +When a set of release keys or project-specific development keys should be +used (e.g. to achieve backward compatibility), a new code signing provider +must be introduced. + +Use ``ptxdist newpackage code-signing-provider`` to generate such a new code +signing provider. +PTXdist distinguishes between "SoftHSM", "HSMs with OpenSC support" and "other +HSMs". +The generated shell script in ``local_src/<name>-code-signing/`` contains +an examples for the selected HSM use case. +See :ref:`code_signing_helper_functions` for an explanation of the available +code signing helpers. +In case of SoftHSM use cases the keys should also be placed inside +``local_src/<name>-code-signing/`` + +In case an HSM is used it is required to extend the ``CODE_SIGNING_ENV`` with +additional environment variables via a pre rule in +``$(PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR)/rules/pre/``. +For SoftHSM such a pre rule exists already in upstream PTXdist in +``rules/pre/020-code-signing-softhsm.make``. +For HSMs with *OpenSC* support a pre rule is generated in +``$(PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR)/rules/pre/020-<name>-code-signing-hsm.make``. +For other HSMs a skeleton pre make file is generated and must be adjusted. + +For example, for Nitrokey HSMs which use OpenSC the generated pre rule looks +like this: + +.. code-block:: make + + ifdef PTXCONF_CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_<NAME> + CODE_SIGNING_ENV += \ + PKCS11_MODULE_PATH="${PTXDIST_SYSROOT_HOST}/lib/pkcs11/opensc-pkcs11.so" + endif + +Note that the module is built in the BSP in this case. +This is not strictly required, it is also possible to use an otherwise +distributed module, e.g. by the HSM manufacturer. +For HSMs supported by OpenSC the required OpenSC selects are generated. +If an HSM without OpenSC support is used the ``select FIXME`` should either be +replaced with an appropriate host tool that provides the PKCS#11 module or +removed altogether if an external PKCS#11 module is used. + +Switching the code signing provider is now finally possible with +``ptxdist platformconfig``, then navigate to *Code signing* → *Code signing +provider*. + +.. _code_signing_consumers: + +Code Signing Consumers +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ + +A package has to select ``CODE_SIGNING`` if it wants to sign something, or if +it needs access to keys and/or certificates. +The config symbol is available in ptxconfig as well as in platformconfig. +Selecting this symbol makes sure the keys and certificates are ready when the +package is being built. + +By adding ``CODE_SIGNING_ENV`` to the package's make/conf/image environment a +tool implementing a PKCS#11 interface can access the HSM or SoftHSM. +The PKCS#11 URI can be retrieved via :ref:`cs_get_uri` and passed on, usually +also via an environment variable. + +:ref:`cs_get_ca` can be used to install a keyring to the root file system, e.g.: + +.. code-block:: none + + $(call install_copy, rauc, 0, 0, 0644, \ + $(shell cs_get_ca update), \ + /etc/rauc/ca.cert.pem) + +.. note:: When code signing helper functions are used in make variables (e.g. + for environment definitions) recursively expanded variables must be used + (``=``, not ``:=``). + Otherwise the variable is expanded before a code signing provider can perform + its setup. -- 2.27.0 _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* Re: [ptxdist] [APPLIED] doc: dev_code_signing: rework and extend code signing section 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 5/6] doc: dev_code_signing: rework and extend code signing section Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-19 22:04 ` Michael Olbrich 0 siblings, 0 replies; 24+ messages in thread From: Michael Olbrich @ 2020-06-19 22:04 UTC (permalink / raw) To: ptxdist; +Cc: Bastian Krause Thanks, applied as e1209bf1f06d2518b7e24f62eca5d64052f94d21. Michael [sent from post-receive hook] On Sat, 20 Jun 2020 00:04:08 +0200, Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> wrote: > Signed-off-by: Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> > Reviewed-by: Roland Hieber <rhi@pengutronix.de> > Tested-by: Ladislav Michl <ladis@linux-mips.org> > Message-Id: <20200617143125.23999-6-bst@pengutronix.de> > Signed-off-by: Michael Olbrich <m.olbrich@pengutronix.de> > > diff --git a/doc/dev_code_signing.rst b/doc/dev_code_signing.rst > index de0087f8b36a..fbebb6b524e1 100644 > --- a/doc/dev_code_signing.rst > +++ b/doc/dev_code_signing.rst > @@ -3,34 +3,136 @@ > Code Signing > ------------ > > -This is an overview over the ptxdist signing infrastructure. > -ptxdist uses PKCS#11 internally for providing access to keys and certificates. > -Packages that wish to sign something should implement a PKCS#11 interface. > +In order to make sure an artifact was created by a known authority and was not > +altered later, digital signatures play a key role when building firmware > +images. > +This is also essential when a verified boot chain is established, e.g. via > +*High Assurance Boot* (HAB), signed FIT images, and a verified root file > +system. > + > +PTXdist uses `PKCS#11 <pkcs11-doc_>`_ internally to provide access to keys and > +certificates, therefore code signing consumers should implement a PKCS#11 > +interface to make use of PTXdist's code signing infrastructure. > > As PKCS#11 URIs usually differ between different usecases (release vs. > -development) the URIs normally are not hardcoded in the package configuration. > -Instead, ptxdist has the idea of "roles" which are string identifiers used to > +development) the URIs are usually not hardcoded in the package configuration. > +Instead, PTXdist has the idea of **roles** which are string identifiers used to > access a single private/public key pair and a certificate. > > -ptxdist supports Hardware Security Modules (HSM). > -In case a HSM is not present or shall not be used SoftHSM is used internally to > -transparently provide the same API internally. > +Finally, one or several **code signing providers** supply the mapping from > +roles to the respective key material or even provide it themselves for > +development. > + > +PTXdist supports *Hardware Security Modules* (HSM). > +In case an HSM is not present or shall not be used, PTXdist can emulate it > +using `SoftHSM <softhsm_>`_, while still transparently providing the same API > +to code signing consumers. > + > +.. _pkcs11-doc: https://www.cryptsoft.com/pkcs11doc/ > +.. _softhsm: https://www.opendnssec.org/softhsm/ > + > +.. _code_signing_providers: > > -For each role a PKCS#11 URI must be known by ptxdist. > -In case of a HSM the keys and certificates are stored in the HSM, but ptxdist > +Code Signing Providers > +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > + > +For each role a PKCS#11 URI must be known by PTXdist. > +In case of an HSM the keys and certificates are stored in the HSM, but PTXdist > needs to know the PKCS#11 URI to access the keys. > -This is done in ptxdist rule files calling cs_set_uri <role> <uri>. > -For SoftHSM the URI is generated internally by ptxdist, but instead the > -keys/certificates for each role have have to be imported. > -This is done with the cs_import_* functions below. > - > -During each invocation of ptxdist exactly one key provider is active. > -The code signing provider can be chosen with the PTXCONF_CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER > -variable. > -A code signing provider is a package resposible for providing the role <-> > -PKCS#11 URI relationships in case a HSM is used or for providing the key > +For SoftHSM the URI is generated internally by PTXdist, but instead the > +keys/certificates for each role have to be imported by the code signing > +provider into the SoftHSM. > + > +A code signing provider is a package responsible for providing the role ↔ > +PKCS#11 URI relationships in case an HSM is used, or for providing the key > material in case SoftHSM is used. > > -A package which wants to sign something or which needs access to keys has to > -select CODE_SIGNING. > -This makes sure the keys are ready when the package is being built. > +When ``PTXCONF_CODE_SIGNING`` is enabled exactly one code signing provider is > +active during each invocation of PTXdist. > + > +PTXdist comes equipped with a development code signing provider "devel" > +implemented via the package ``host-ptx-code-signing-dev``. > +It imports publicly available development keys for each role into the SoftHSM. > + > +.. important:: The ``host-ptx-code-signing-dev`` code signing provider can be > + used to sign artifacts for development purposes, but **must not** be used for > + production. > + > +Creating Custom Code Signing Providers > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +When a set of release keys or project-specific development keys should be > +used (e.g. to achieve backward compatibility), a new code signing provider > +must be introduced. > + > +Use ``ptxdist newpackage code-signing-provider`` to generate such a new code > +signing provider. > +PTXdist distinguishes between "SoftHSM", "HSMs with OpenSC support" and "other > +HSMs". > +The generated shell script in ``local_src/<name>-code-signing/`` contains > +an examples for the selected HSM use case. > +See :ref:`code_signing_helper_functions` for an explanation of the available > +code signing helpers. > +In case of SoftHSM use cases the keys should also be placed inside > +``local_src/<name>-code-signing/`` > + > +In case an HSM is used it is required to extend the ``CODE_SIGNING_ENV`` with > +additional environment variables via a pre rule in > +``$(PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR)/rules/pre/``. > +For SoftHSM such a pre rule exists already in upstream PTXdist in > +``rules/pre/020-code-signing-softhsm.make``. > +For HSMs with *OpenSC* support a pre rule is generated in > +``$(PTXDIST_PLATFORMCONFIGDIR)/rules/pre/020-<name>-code-signing-hsm.make``. > +For other HSMs a skeleton pre make file is generated and must be adjusted. > + > +For example, for Nitrokey HSMs which use OpenSC the generated pre rule looks > +like this: > + > +.. code-block:: make > + > + ifdef PTXCONF_CODE_SIGNING_PROVIDER_<NAME> > + CODE_SIGNING_ENV += \ > + PKCS11_MODULE_PATH="${PTXDIST_SYSROOT_HOST}/lib/pkcs11/opensc-pkcs11.so" > + endif > + > +Note that the module is built in the BSP in this case. > +This is not strictly required, it is also possible to use an otherwise > +distributed module, e.g. by the HSM manufacturer. > +For HSMs supported by OpenSC the required OpenSC selects are generated. > +If an HSM without OpenSC support is used the ``select FIXME`` should either be > +replaced with an appropriate host tool that provides the PKCS#11 module or > +removed altogether if an external PKCS#11 module is used. > + > +Switching the code signing provider is now finally possible with > +``ptxdist platformconfig``, then navigate to *Code signing* → *Code signing > +provider*. > + > +.. _code_signing_consumers: > + > +Code Signing Consumers > +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > + > +A package has to select ``CODE_SIGNING`` if it wants to sign something, or if > +it needs access to keys and/or certificates. > +The config symbol is available in ptxconfig as well as in platformconfig. > +Selecting this symbol makes sure the keys and certificates are ready when the > +package is being built. > + > +By adding ``CODE_SIGNING_ENV`` to the package's make/conf/image environment a > +tool implementing a PKCS#11 interface can access the HSM or SoftHSM. > +The PKCS#11 URI can be retrieved via :ref:`cs_get_uri` and passed on, usually > +also via an environment variable. > + > +:ref:`cs_get_ca` can be used to install a keyring to the root file system, e.g.: > + > +.. code-block:: none > + > + $(call install_copy, rauc, 0, 0, 0644, \ > + $(shell cs_get_ca update), \ > + /etc/rauc/ca.cert.pem) > + > +.. note:: When code signing helper functions are used in make variables (e.g. > + for environment definitions) recursively expanded variables must be used > + (``=``, not ``:=``). > + Otherwise the variable is expanded before a code signing provider can perform > + its setup. _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 6/6] doc: introduce ref_code_signing_helpers 2020-06-17 14:31 [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 0/6] Add code-signing-provider template, add code signing docs Bastian Krause ` (4 preceding siblings ...) 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 5/6] doc: dev_code_signing: rework and extend code signing section Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-17 14:31 ` Bastian Krause 2020-06-19 22:04 ` [ptxdist] [APPLIED] " Michael Olbrich 5 siblings, 1 reply; 24+ messages in thread From: Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-17 14:31 UTC (permalink / raw) To: ptxdist; +Cc: Bastian Krause, Roland Hieber Signed-off-by: Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> Reviewed-by: Roland Hieber <rhi@pengutronix.de> Tested-by: Ladislav Michl <ladis@linux-mips.org> --- Changes since v2: - remove "necessary package dependencies for code signing provider", generated code signing providers now select all necessary host tools by default Changes since (implicit) v1: - rebased on master - split into sections: {SoftHSM Provider,Generic Provider,Consumer} Functions - add introductory sentence for each section --- doc/ref_code_signing_helpers.rst | 248 +++++++++++++++++++++++++++++++ doc/ref_manual.rst | 1 + 2 files changed, 249 insertions(+) create mode 100644 doc/ref_code_signing_helpers.rst diff --git a/doc/ref_code_signing_helpers.rst b/doc/ref_code_signing_helpers.rst new file mode 100644 index 000000000..c3ffe01cb --- /dev/null +++ b/doc/ref_code_signing_helpers.rst @@ -0,0 +1,248 @@ +.. _code_signing_helper_functions: + +Code Signing Helper Functions +----------------------------- + +PTXdist provides various bash helper functions to be used in :ref:`code signing +providers <code_signing_providers>` and :ref:`code signing consumers +<code_signing_consumers>`. + +PTXdist stores URIs and CAs using these helpers in +``$(PTXDIST_SYSROOT_HOST)/var/lib/keys/<signing-provider>/<role>/{uri,ca.pem}``. + +SoftHSM Provider Functions +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ + +These helpers initialize and import public/private keys and certificates into +the SoftHSM. + +.. _cs_init_softhsm: + +cs_init_softhsm +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +Usage: + +.. code-block:: bash + + cs_init_softhsm + +Initialize SoftHSM, and set the initial pins. + +cs_import_cert_from_der +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +Usage: + +.. code-block:: bash + + cs_import_cert_from_der <role> <DER> + +Import certificate from a given DER file for role. +To be used with SoftHSM only. + +Preconditions: + +- the role must have been defined (see :ref:`cs_define_role`) +- SoftHSM must have been initialized (see :ref:`cs_init_softhsm`) + +cs_import_cert_from_pem +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +Usage: + +.. code-block:: bash + + cs_import_cert_from_pem <role> <PEM> + +Import certificate from a given PEM file for role. +To be used with SoftHSM only. + +Preconditions: + +- the role must have been defined (see :ref:`cs_define_role`) +- SoftHSM must have been initialized (see :ref:`cs_init_softhsm`) + +cs_import_pubkey_from_pem +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +Usage: + +.. code-block:: bash + + cs_import_pubkey_from_pem <role> <PEM> + +Import public key from a given PEM file for role. +To be used with SoftHSM only. + +Preconditions: + +- the role must have been defined (see :ref:`cs_define_role`) +- SoftHSM must have been initialized (see :ref:`cs_init_softhsm`) + +cs_import_privkey_from_pem +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +Usage: + +.. code-block:: bash + + cs_import_privkey_from_pem <role> <PEM> + +Import private key from a given PEM file for role. +To be used with SoftHSM only. + +Preconditions: + +- the role must have been defined (see :ref:`cs_define_role`) +- SoftHSM must have been initialized (see :ref:`cs_init_softhsm`) + +cs_import_key_from_pem +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +Usage: + +.. code-block:: bash + + cs_import_key_from_pem <role> <PEM> + +Import private/public key pair from a given PEM file for role. +To be used with SoftHSM only. + +Preconditions: + +- the role must have been defined (see :ref:`cs_define_role`) +- SoftHSM must have been initialized (see :ref:`cs_init_softhsm`) + +Generic Provider Functions +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ + +These helpers allow to define roles, set PKCS#11 URIs and handle certificate +authorities (CAs). +HSM as well as SoftHSM code signing providers should use them. + +.. _cs_define_role: + +cs_define_role +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +Usage: + +.. code-block:: bash + + cs_define_role <role> + +Define new key role. + +A default PKCS#11 URI is set implicitly as convenience for SoftHSM use cases. + +.. _cs_set_uri: + +cs_set_uri +^^^^^^^^^^ + +Usage: + +.. code-block:: bash + + cs_set_uri <role> <URI> + +Set given PKCS#11 URI for role. + +Preconditions: + +- the role must have been defined (see :ref:`cs_define_role`) + +.. _cs_append_ca_from_pem: + +cs_append_ca_from_pem +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +Usage: + +.. code-block:: bash + + cs_append_ca_from_pem <role> <PEM> + +Append certificate from a given PEM file for role. + +Preconditions: + +- the role must have been defined (see :ref:`cs_define_role`) + +.. _cs_append_ca_from_der: + +cs_append_ca_from_der +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +Usage: + +.. code-block:: bash + + cs_append_ca_from_der <role> <DER> + +Append certificate from a given DER file for role. + +Preconditions: + +- the role must have been defined (see :ref:`cs_define_role`) + +.. _cs_append_ca_from_uri: + +cs_append_ca_from_uri +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ + +Usage: + +.. code-block:: bash + + cs_append_ca_from_uri <role> [<URI>] + +Append certificate from a given PKCS#11 URI for role. +If URI is omitted the already set URI for role is used. + +Preconditions: + +- the role must have been defined (see :ref:`cs_define_role`) + +Consumer Functions +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ + +Packages that want to sign something or need access to keys/CAs can retrieve +PKCS#11 URIs and CAs with these helpers. + +.. _cs_get_uri: + +cs_get_uri +^^^^^^^^^^ + +Usage: + +.. code-block:: bash + + cs_get_uri <role> + +Get PKCS#11 URI for role. + +Preconditions: + +- the URI must have been set (see :ref:`cs_set_uri`) + +.. _cs_get_ca: + +cs_get_ca +^^^^^^^^^ + +Usage: + +.. code-block:: bash + + cs_get_ca <role> + +Get path to the CA in PEM format for role. + +Preconditions: + +- a certificate must have been appended to the CA + (see :ref:`cs_append_ca_from_pem`, :ref:`cs_append_ca_from_der`, + :ref:`cs_append_ca_from_uri`) diff --git a/doc/ref_manual.rst b/doc/ref_manual.rst index 850d72399..dea1610c6 100644 --- a/doc/ref_manual.rst +++ b/doc/ref_manual.rst @@ -7,3 +7,4 @@ PTXdist Reference ref_make_macros ref_rule_file_layout ref_parameter + ref_code_signing_helpers -- 2.27.0 _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
* Re: [ptxdist] [APPLIED] doc: introduce ref_code_signing_helpers 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 6/6] doc: introduce ref_code_signing_helpers Bastian Krause @ 2020-06-19 22:04 ` Michael Olbrich 0 siblings, 0 replies; 24+ messages in thread From: Michael Olbrich @ 2020-06-19 22:04 UTC (permalink / raw) To: ptxdist; +Cc: Bastian Krause Thanks, applied as a1fff163e86b45aab29fda3790542422eaa5fd61. Michael [sent from post-receive hook] On Sat, 20 Jun 2020 00:04:09 +0200, Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> wrote: > Signed-off-by: Bastian Krause <bst@pengutronix.de> > Reviewed-by: Roland Hieber <rhi@pengutronix.de> > Tested-by: Ladislav Michl <ladis@linux-mips.org> > Message-Id: <20200617143125.23999-7-bst@pengutronix.de> > Signed-off-by: Michael Olbrich <m.olbrich@pengutronix.de> > > diff --git a/doc/ref_code_signing_helpers.rst b/doc/ref_code_signing_helpers.rst > new file mode 100644 > index 000000000000..c3ffe01cbdac > --- /dev/null > +++ b/doc/ref_code_signing_helpers.rst > @@ -0,0 +1,248 @@ > +.. _code_signing_helper_functions: > + > +Code Signing Helper Functions > +----------------------------- > + > +PTXdist provides various bash helper functions to be used in :ref:`code signing > +providers <code_signing_providers>` and :ref:`code signing consumers > +<code_signing_consumers>`. > + > +PTXdist stores URIs and CAs using these helpers in > +``$(PTXDIST_SYSROOT_HOST)/var/lib/keys/<signing-provider>/<role>/{uri,ca.pem}``. > + > +SoftHSM Provider Functions > +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > + > +These helpers initialize and import public/private keys and certificates into > +the SoftHSM. > + > +.. _cs_init_softhsm: > + > +cs_init_softhsm > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +Usage: > + > +.. code-block:: bash > + > + cs_init_softhsm > + > +Initialize SoftHSM, and set the initial pins. > + > +cs_import_cert_from_der > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +Usage: > + > +.. code-block:: bash > + > + cs_import_cert_from_der <role> <DER> > + > +Import certificate from a given DER file for role. > +To be used with SoftHSM only. > + > +Preconditions: > + > +- the role must have been defined (see :ref:`cs_define_role`) > +- SoftHSM must have been initialized (see :ref:`cs_init_softhsm`) > + > +cs_import_cert_from_pem > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +Usage: > + > +.. code-block:: bash > + > + cs_import_cert_from_pem <role> <PEM> > + > +Import certificate from a given PEM file for role. > +To be used with SoftHSM only. > + > +Preconditions: > + > +- the role must have been defined (see :ref:`cs_define_role`) > +- SoftHSM must have been initialized (see :ref:`cs_init_softhsm`) > + > +cs_import_pubkey_from_pem > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +Usage: > + > +.. code-block:: bash > + > + cs_import_pubkey_from_pem <role> <PEM> > + > +Import public key from a given PEM file for role. > +To be used with SoftHSM only. > + > +Preconditions: > + > +- the role must have been defined (see :ref:`cs_define_role`) > +- SoftHSM must have been initialized (see :ref:`cs_init_softhsm`) > + > +cs_import_privkey_from_pem > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +Usage: > + > +.. code-block:: bash > + > + cs_import_privkey_from_pem <role> <PEM> > + > +Import private key from a given PEM file for role. > +To be used with SoftHSM only. > + > +Preconditions: > + > +- the role must have been defined (see :ref:`cs_define_role`) > +- SoftHSM must have been initialized (see :ref:`cs_init_softhsm`) > + > +cs_import_key_from_pem > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +Usage: > + > +.. code-block:: bash > + > + cs_import_key_from_pem <role> <PEM> > + > +Import private/public key pair from a given PEM file for role. > +To be used with SoftHSM only. > + > +Preconditions: > + > +- the role must have been defined (see :ref:`cs_define_role`) > +- SoftHSM must have been initialized (see :ref:`cs_init_softhsm`) > + > +Generic Provider Functions > +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > + > +These helpers allow to define roles, set PKCS#11 URIs and handle certificate > +authorities (CAs). > +HSM as well as SoftHSM code signing providers should use them. > + > +.. _cs_define_role: > + > +cs_define_role > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +Usage: > + > +.. code-block:: bash > + > + cs_define_role <role> > + > +Define new key role. > + > +A default PKCS#11 URI is set implicitly as convenience for SoftHSM use cases. > + > +.. _cs_set_uri: > + > +cs_set_uri > +^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +Usage: > + > +.. code-block:: bash > + > + cs_set_uri <role> <URI> > + > +Set given PKCS#11 URI for role. > + > +Preconditions: > + > +- the role must have been defined (see :ref:`cs_define_role`) > + > +.. _cs_append_ca_from_pem: > + > +cs_append_ca_from_pem > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +Usage: > + > +.. code-block:: bash > + > + cs_append_ca_from_pem <role> <PEM> > + > +Append certificate from a given PEM file for role. > + > +Preconditions: > + > +- the role must have been defined (see :ref:`cs_define_role`) > + > +.. _cs_append_ca_from_der: > + > +cs_append_ca_from_der > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +Usage: > + > +.. code-block:: bash > + > + cs_append_ca_from_der <role> <DER> > + > +Append certificate from a given DER file for role. > + > +Preconditions: > + > +- the role must have been defined (see :ref:`cs_define_role`) > + > +.. _cs_append_ca_from_uri: > + > +cs_append_ca_from_uri > +^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +Usage: > + > +.. code-block:: bash > + > + cs_append_ca_from_uri <role> [<URI>] > + > +Append certificate from a given PKCS#11 URI for role. > +If URI is omitted the already set URI for role is used. > + > +Preconditions: > + > +- the role must have been defined (see :ref:`cs_define_role`) > + > +Consumer Functions > +~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~ > + > +Packages that want to sign something or need access to keys/CAs can retrieve > +PKCS#11 URIs and CAs with these helpers. > + > +.. _cs_get_uri: > + > +cs_get_uri > +^^^^^^^^^^ > + > +Usage: > + > +.. code-block:: bash > + > + cs_get_uri <role> > + > +Get PKCS#11 URI for role. > + > +Preconditions: > + > +- the URI must have been set (see :ref:`cs_set_uri`) > + > +.. _cs_get_ca: > + > +cs_get_ca > +^^^^^^^^^ > + > +Usage: > + > +.. code-block:: bash > + > + cs_get_ca <role> > + > +Get path to the CA in PEM format for role. > + > +Preconditions: > + > +- a certificate must have been appended to the CA > + (see :ref:`cs_append_ca_from_pem`, :ref:`cs_append_ca_from_der`, > + :ref:`cs_append_ca_from_uri`) > diff --git a/doc/ref_manual.rst b/doc/ref_manual.rst > index 850d7239914b..dea1610c6e42 100644 > --- a/doc/ref_manual.rst > +++ b/doc/ref_manual.rst > @@ -7,3 +7,4 @@ PTXdist Reference > ref_make_macros > ref_rule_file_layout > ref_parameter > + ref_code_signing_helpers _______________________________________________ ptxdist mailing list ptxdist@pengutronix.de To unsubscribe, send a mail with subject "unsubscribe" to ptxdist-request@pengutronix.de ^ permalink raw reply [flat|nested] 24+ messages in thread
end of thread, other threads:[~2020-09-24 12:23 UTC | newest] Thread overview: 24+ messages (download: mbox.gz / follow: Atom feed) -- links below jump to the message on this page -- 2020-06-17 14:31 [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 0/6] Add code-signing-provider template, add code signing docs Bastian Krause 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 1/6] ptxd_lib_template: add ptxd_template_read_options Bastian Krause 2020-06-19 6:24 ` Michael Olbrich 2020-06-19 8:13 ` Bastian Krause 2020-06-19 22:04 ` [ptxdist] [APPLIED] " Michael Olbrich 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 2/6] package templates: add code-signing-provider template Bastian Krause 2020-06-18 11:40 ` Roland Hieber 2020-06-18 11:50 ` Bastian Krause 2020-06-19 6:12 ` Michael Olbrich 2020-06-19 6:28 ` Michael Olbrich 2020-06-19 7:52 ` Bastian Krause 2020-06-19 22:04 ` [ptxdist] [APPLIED] " Michael Olbrich 2020-09-24 10:04 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 2/6] " Ladislav Michl 2020-09-24 11:05 ` Bastian Krause 2020-09-24 11:15 ` Ladislav Michl 2020-09-24 12:23 ` Bastian Krause 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 3/6] doc: dev_manual: split up into multiple files Bastian Krause 2020-06-19 22:04 ` [ptxdist] [APPLIED] " Michael Olbrich 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 4/6] doc: move code signing docs from scripts/ into doc/ Bastian Krause 2020-06-19 22:04 ` [ptxdist] [APPLIED] " Michael Olbrich 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 5/6] doc: dev_code_signing: rework and extend code signing section Bastian Krause 2020-06-19 22:04 ` [ptxdist] [APPLIED] " Michael Olbrich 2020-06-17 14:31 ` [ptxdist] [PATCH v3 6/6] doc: introduce ref_code_signing_helpers Bastian Krause 2020-06-19 22:04 ` [ptxdist] [APPLIED] " Michael Olbrich
This is a public inbox, see mirroring instructions for how to clone and mirror all data and code used for this inbox